图片仅供参考

详细数据请看参考数据手册

Datasheet下载
  • 型号: ST72F324BK2T6
  • 制造商: STMicroelectronics
  • 库位|库存: xxxx|xxxx
  • 要求:
数量阶梯 香港交货 国内含税
+xxxx $xxxx ¥xxxx

查看当月历史价格

查看今年历史价格

ST72F324BK2T6产品简介:

ICGOO电子元器件商城为您提供ST72F324BK2T6由STMicroelectronics设计生产,在icgoo商城现货销售,并且可以通过原厂、代理商等渠道进行代购。 ST72F324BK2T6价格参考。STMicroelectronicsST72F324BK2T6封装/规格:嵌入式 - 微控制器, ST7 微控制器 IC ST7 8-位 8MHz 8KB(8K x 8) 闪存 。您可以下载ST72F324BK2T6参考资料、Datasheet数据手册功能说明书,资料中有ST72F324BK2T6 详细功能的应用电路图电压和使用方法及教程。

产品参数 图文手册 常见问题
参数 数值
产品目录

集成电路 (IC)

描述

IC MCU 8BIT 8K FLASH 32-LQFP

EEPROM容量

-

产品分类

嵌入式 - 微控制器

I/O数

24

品牌

STMicroelectronics

数据手册

点击此处下载产品Datasheet

产品图片

产品型号

ST72F324BK2T6

RAM容量

384 x 8

rohs

无铅 / 符合限制有害物质指令(RoHS)规范要求

产品系列

ST7

供应商器件封装

*

其它名称

497-5592

其它有关文件

http://www.st.com/web/catalog/mmc/FM141/SC1714/LN1290/PF111245?referrer=70071840

包装

托盘

外设

LVD,POR,PWM,WDT

封装/外壳

32-LQFP

工作温度

-40°C ~ 85°C

振荡器类型

内部

数据转换器

A/D 12x10b

标准包装

250

核心处理器

ST7

核心尺寸

8-位

特色产品

http://www.digikey.com/product-highlights/cn/zh/segger-microcontroller-systems-flasher-tools/3226

电压-电源(Vcc/Vdd)

3.8 V ~ 5.5 V

程序存储器类型

闪存

程序存储容量

8KB(8K x 8)

连接性

SCI,SPI

速度

8MHz

配用

/product-detail/zh/STEVAL-ISB002V1/497-6421-ND/1786211/product-detail/zh/STX-RLINK/497-5046-ND/1013435

推荐商品

型号:XF28M36P63C2ZWTT

品牌:Texas Instruments

产品名称:集成电路(IC)

获取报价

型号:PIC18F6621-E/PT

品牌:Microchip Technology

产品名称:集成电路(IC)

获取报价

型号:PIC16LF727-E/P

品牌:Microchip Technology

产品名称:集成电路(IC)

获取报价

型号:PIC12F1612T-I/MF

品牌:Microchip Technology

产品名称:集成电路(IC)

获取报价

型号:C8051F230-GQR

品牌:Silicon Labs

产品名称:集成电路(IC)

获取报价

型号:STM8S103F3P3TR

品牌:STMicroelectronics

产品名称:集成电路(IC)

获取报价

型号:DSPIC33EP64MC202-I/SS

品牌:Microchip Technology

产品名称:集成电路(IC)

获取报价

型号:PIC32MX170F256B-50I/ML

品牌:Microchip Technology

产品名称:集成电路(IC)

获取报价

样品试用

万种样品免费试用

去申请
ST72F324BK2T6 相关产品

DF2215CUTE24V

品牌:Renesas Electronics America

价格:

R5F21226KFP#U1

品牌:Renesas Electronics America

价格:

PIC16F1503T-I/ST

品牌:Microchip Technology

价格:

DSPIC33EP256GP506-E/MR

品牌:Microchip Technology

价格:

PIC16F1934-I/PT

品牌:Microchip Technology

价格:

MC68376BGMAB20

品牌:NXP USA Inc.

价格:

AT91SAM7S32-MU

品牌:Microchip Technology

价格:

PIC12HV615T-I/MF

品牌:Microchip Technology

价格:

PDF Datasheet 数据手册内容提取

ST72324Bxx 8-bit MCU, 3.8 to 5.5 V operating range with 8 to 32 Kbyte Flash/ROM, 10-bit ADC, 4 timers, SPI, SCI Features Memories ■ 8 to 32Kbyte dual voltage High Density Flash (HDFlash) or ROM with readout protection LQFP44 LQFP32 10 x 10 7 x 7 capability. In-application programming and In- circuit programming for HDFlash devices ■ 384bytes to 1Kbyte RAM ■ HDFlash endurance: 1 kcycle at 55 °C, data SDIP42 SDIP32 retention 40 years at 85 °C 600 mil 400 mil Clock, reset and supply management 4 timers ■ Enhanced low voltage supervisor (LVD) with ■ Main clock controller with real-time base, Beep programmable reset thresholds and auxiliary and clock-out capabilities voltage detector (AVD) with interrupt capability ■ Configurable watchdog timer ■ Clock sources: crystal/ceramic resonator ■ 16-bit Timer A with 1 input capture, 1 output oscillators, int. RC osc. and ext. clock input compare, ext. clock input, PWM and pulse ■ PLL for 2x frequency multiplication generator modes ■ 4 power saving modes: Slow, Wait, Active-halt, ■ 16-bit Timer B with 2 input captures, 2 output and Halt compares, PWM and pulse generator modes Interrupt management 2 communication interfaces ■ Nested interrupt controller. 10 interrupt vectors ■ SPI synchronous serial interface plus TRAP and RESET. 9/6 ext. interrupt lines ■ SCI asynchronous serial interface (on 4 vectors) 1 analog peripheral (low current coupling) Up to 32 I/O ports ■ 10-bit ADC with up to 12 input ports ■ 32/24 multifunctional bidirectional I/Os, 22/17 alternate function lines, Development tools 12/10 high sink outputs ■ In-circuit testing capability Table 1. Device summary Device Memory RAM (stack) Voltage range Temp. range Package ST72324BK2 Flash/ROM 8 Kbytes 384(256) bytes LQFP32 ST72324BK4 Flash/ROM 16 Kbytes 512(256) bytes 7x7/ ST72324BK6 Flash/ROM 32 Kbytes 1024(256) bytes up to SDIP32 3.8 to 5.5 V ST72324BJ2 Flash/ROM 8 Kbytes 384(256) bytes -40 to 125 °C LQFP44 ST72324BJ4 Flash/ROM 16 Kbytes 512(256) bytes 10x10/ ST72324BJ6 Flash/ROM 32 Kbytes 1024(256) bytes SDIP42 March 2009 Rev 7 1/193 www.st.com 1

Contents ST72324Bxx Contents 1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 2 Pin description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 3 Register and memory map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 4 Flash program memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 4.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 4.2 Main features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 4.3 Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 4.3.1 Readout protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 4.4 ICC interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 4.5 ICP (in-circuit programming) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 4.6 IAP (in-application programming) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 4.7 Related documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 4.7.1 Flash Control/Status Register (FCSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 5 Central processing unit (CPU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 5.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 5.2 Main features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 5.3 CPU registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 5.3.1 Accumulator (A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 5.3.2 Index registers (X and Y) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 5.3.3 Program counter (PC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 5.3.4 Condition Code register (CC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 5.3.5 Stack Pointer register (SP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 6 Supply, reset and clock management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 6.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 6.2 PLL (phase locked loop) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 6.3 Multi-oscillator (MO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 6.3.1 External clock source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 6.3.2 Crystal/ceramic oscillators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 2/193

ST72324Bxx Contents 6.3.3 Internal RC oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 6.4 Reset sequence manager (RSM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 6.4.1 Asynchronous external RESET pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 6.5 System integrity management (SI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 6.5.1 LVD (low voltage detector) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 6.5.2 AVD (auxiliary voltage detector) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 6.5.3 Low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 6.5.4 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 6.6 SI registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 6.6.1 System integrity (SI) control/status register (SICSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 7 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 7.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 7.2 Masking and processing flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 7.2.1 Servicing pending interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 7.2.2 Different interrupt vector sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 7.2.3 Non-maskable sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 7.2.4 Maskable sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 7.3 Interrupts and low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 7.4 Concurrent and nested management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 7.5 Interrupt registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 7.5.1 CPU CC register interrupt bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 7.5.2 Interrupt software priority registers (ISPRx) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 7.6 External interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 7.6.1 I/O port interrupt sensitivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 7.6.2 External interrupt control register (EICR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 8 Power saving modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 8.2 Slow mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 8.3 Wait mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 8.4 Active-halt and Halt modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 8.4.1 Active-halt mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 8.4.2 Halt mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 9 I/O ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 3/193

Contents ST72324Bxx 9.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 9.2 Functional description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 9.2.1 Input modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 9.2.2 Output modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 9.2.3 Alternate functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 9.3 I/O port implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 9.4 Low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 9.5 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 9.5.1 I/O port implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 10 On-chip peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 10.1 Watchdog timer (WDG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 10.1.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 10.1.2 Main features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 10.1.3 Functional description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 10.1.4 How to program the Watchdog timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 10.1.5 Low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 10.1.6 Hardware Watchdog option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 10.1.7 Using Halt mode with the WDG (WDGHALT option) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 10.1.8 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 10.1.9 Control register (WDGCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 10.2 Main clock controller with real-time clock and beeper (MCC/RTC) . . . . . 69 10.2.1 Programmable CPU clock prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 10.2.2 Clock-out capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 10.2.3 Real-time clock (RTC) timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 10.2.4 Beeper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 10.2.5 Low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 10.2.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 10.2.7 MCC registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 10.3 16-bit timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 10.3.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 10.3.2 Main features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 10.3.3 Functional description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 10.3.4 Low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 10.3.5 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 10.3.6 Summary of timer modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 4/193

ST72324Bxx Contents 10.3.7 16-bit timer registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 10.4 Serial peripheral interface (SPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 10.4.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 10.4.2 Main features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 10.4.3 General description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 10.4.4 Clock phase and clock polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 10.4.5 Error flags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 10.4.6 Low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 10.4.7 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 10.4.8 SPI registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 10.5 Serial communications interface (SCI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 10.5.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 10.5.2 Main features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 10.5.3 General description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 10.5.4 Functional description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 10.5.5 Low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 10.5.6 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 10.5.7 SCI registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 10.6 10-bit A/D converter (ADC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 10.6.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 10.6.2 Main features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 10.6.3 Functional description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 10.6.4 Low power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 10.6.5 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 10.6.6 ADC registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 11 Instruction set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 11.1 CPU addressing modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 11.1.1 Inherent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 11.1.2 Immediate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 11.1.3 Direct . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 11.1.4 Indexed (no offset, short, long) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 11.1.5 Indirect (short, long) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 11.1.6 Indirect indexed (short, long) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 11.1.7 Relative mode (direct, indirect) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 11.2 Instruction groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 5/193

Contents ST72324Bxx 12 Electrical characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 12.1 Parameter conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 12.1.1 Minimum and maximum values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 12.1.2 Typical values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 12.1.3 Typical curves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 12.1.4 Loading capacitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 12.1.5 Pin input voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 12.2 Absolute maximum ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 12.2.1 Voltage characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 12.2.2 Current characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 12.2.3 Thermal characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 12.3 Operating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 12.4 LVD/AVD characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 12.4.1 Operating conditions with LVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 12.4.2 Auxiliary voltage detector (AVD) thresholds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 12.5 Supply current characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 12.5.1 ROM current consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 12.5.2 Flash current consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 12.5.3 Supply and clock managers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 12.5.4 On-chip peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 12.6 Clock and timing characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 12.6.1 General timings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 12.6.2 External clock source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 12.6.3 Crystal and ceramic resonator oscillators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 12.6.4 RC oscillators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 12.6.5 PLL characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 12.7 Memory characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 12.7.1 RAM and hardware registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 12.7.2 Flash memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 12.8 EMC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 12.8.1 Functional electromagnetic susceptibility (EMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 12.8.2 Electromagnetic interference (EMI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 12.8.3 Absolute maximum ratings (electrical sensitivity) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 12.9 I/O port pin characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 12.9.1 General characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 12.9.2 Output driving current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 6/193

ST72324Bxx Contents 12.10 Control pin characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 12.10.1 Asynchronous RESET pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 12.10.2 ICCSEL/VPP pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 12.11 Timer peripheral characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 12.11.1 16-bit timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 12.12 Communication interface characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 12.12.1 Serial peripheral interface (SPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 12.13 10-bit ADC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 12.13.1 Analog power supply and reference pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 12.13.2 General PCB design guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 12.13.3 ADC accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 13 Package characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 13.1 ECOPACK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 13.2 Package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 13.2.1 LQFP44 package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 13.2.2 SDIP42 package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 13.2.3 LQFP32 package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 13.2.4 SDIP32 package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 13.3 Thermal characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 14 Device configuration and ordering information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 14.1 Flash devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 14.1.1 Flash configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 14.2 ROM devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 14.2.1 Transfer of customer code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 14.3 Development tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 14.3.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 14.3.2 Evaluation tools and starter kits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 14.3.3 Development and debugging tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 14.3.4 Programming tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 14.3.5 Socket and emulator adapter information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 14.4 ST7 Application notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 15 Known limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 15.1 All Flash and ROM devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 7/193

Contents ST72324Bxx 15.1.1 Safe connection of OSC1/OSC2 pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 15.1.2 External interrupt missed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 15.1.3 Unexpected reset fetch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 15.1.4 Clearing active interrupts outside interrupt routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 15.1.5 16-bit timer PWM mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 15.1.6 TIMD set simultaneously with OC interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 15.1.7 SCI wrong break duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 15.2 8/16 Kbyte Flash devices only . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 15.2.1 39-pulse ICC entry mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 15.2.2 Negative current injection on pin PB0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 15.3 8/16 Kbyte ROM devices only . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 15.3.1 Readout protection with LVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 15.3.2 I/O Port A and F configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 16 Revision history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 8/193

ST72324Bxx List of tables List of tables Table 1. Device summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Table 2. Device pin description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Table 3. Hardware register map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Table 4. Sectors available in Flash devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Table 5. Flash control/status register address and reset value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Table 6. Arithmetic management bits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Table 7. Software interrupt bits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Table 8. Interrupt software priority selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Table 9. ST7 clock sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Table 10. Effect of low power modes on SI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Table 11. AVD interrupt control/wakeup capability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Table 12. SICSR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Table 13. Reset source flags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Table 14. Interrupt software priority levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Table 15. CPU CC register interrupt bits description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Table 16. Interrupt software priority levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Table 17. ISPRx interrupt vector correspondence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Table 18. Dedicated interrupt instruction set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Table 19. EICR register description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Table 20. Interrupt sensitivity - ei2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Table 21. Interrupt sensitivity - ei3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Table 22. Interrupt sensitivity - ei0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Table 23. Interrupt sensitivity - ei1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Table 24. Nested interrupts register map and reset values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Table 25. Interrupt mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Table 26. MCC/RTC low power mode selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Table 27. DR register value and output pin status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Table 28. I/O port mode options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Table 29. I/O port configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Table 30. Effect of low power modes on I/O ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Table 31. I/O port interrupt control/wakeup capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Table 32. Port configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Table 33. I/O port register map and reset values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Table 34. Effect of lower power modes on Watchdog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 Table 35. WDGCR register description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Table 36. Watchdog timer register map and reset values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Table 37. Effect of low power modes on MCC/RTC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Table 38. MCC/RTC interrupt control/wakeup capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Table 39. MCCSR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Table 40. Time base selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Table 41. MCCBCR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Table 42. Beep frequency selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Table 43. Main clock controller register map and reset values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 Table 44. Input capture byte distribution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Table 45. Output compare byte distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Table 46. Effect of low power modes on 16-bit timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Table 47. 16-bit timer interrupt control/wakeup capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Table 48. Summary of timer modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 9/193

List of tables ST72324Bxx Table 49. CR1 register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Table 50. CR2 register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Table 51. CSR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Table 52. 16-bit timer register map and reset values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Table 53. Effect of low power modes on SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Table 54. SPI interrupt control/wakeup capability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Table 55. SPICR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Table 56. SPI master mode SCK frequency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Table 57. SPICSR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Table 58. SPI register map and reset values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Table 59. Frame formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Table 60. Effect of low power modes on SCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Table 61. SCI interrupt control/wakeup capability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Table 62. SCISR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Table 63. SCICR1 register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 Table 64. SCICR2 register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Table 65. SCIBRR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Table 66. SCIERPR register description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Table 67. SCIETPR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Table 68. Baud rate selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Table 69. SCI register map and reset values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Table 70. Effect of low power modes on ADC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Table 71. ADCCSR register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 Table 72. ADCDRH register description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Table 73. ADCDRL register description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Table 74. ADC register map and reset values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Table 75. Addressing mode groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Table 76. CPU addressing mode overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Table 77. Inherent instructions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Table 78. Immediate instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Table 79. Instructions supporting direct, indexed, indirect and indirect indexed addressing modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Table 80. Relative direct and indirect instructions and functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 Table 81. Instruction groups. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 Table 82. Instruction set overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Table 83. Voltage characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Table 84. Current characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Table 85. Thermal characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Table 86. Operating conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Table 87. Operating conditions with LVD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Table 88. AVD thresholds. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Table 89. ROM current consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 Table 90. Flash current consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Table 91. Oscillators, PLL and LVD current consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Table 92. On-chip peripherals current consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Table 93. General timings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Table 94. External clock source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Table 95. Crystal and ceramic resonator oscillators (8/16 Kbyte Flash and ROM devices) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Table 96. Crystal and ceramic resonator oscillators (32Kbyte Flash and ROM devices) . . . . . . . . 151 Table 97. OSCRANGE selection for typical resonators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Table 98. RC oscillators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 10/193

ST72324Bxx List of tables Table 99. PLL characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Table 100. RAM and hardware registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Table 101. Dual voltage HDFlash memory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Table 102. EMS test results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Table 103. EMI emissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Table 104. Absolute maximum ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Table 105. Electrical sensitivities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Table 106. General characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Table 107. Output driving current. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Table 108. Asynchronous RESET pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Table 109. ICCSEL/V pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 PP Table 110. 16-bit timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Table 111. SPI characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Table 112. 10-bit ADC characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 Table 113. ADC accuracy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Table 114. 44-pin low profile quad flat package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Table 115. 42-pin dual in line package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Table 116. 32-pin low profile quad flat package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Table 117. 32-pin dual in-line package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 Table 118. Thermal characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Table 119. Flash option bytes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 Table 120. Option byte 0 bit description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 Table 121. Option byte 1 bit description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 Table 122. Package selection (OPT7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Table 123. STMicroelectronics development tools. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Table 124. Suggested list of socket types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Table 125. Port A and F configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Table 126. Document revision history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 11/193

List of figures ST72324Bxx List of figures Figure 1. Device block diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Figure 2. 44-pin LQFP package pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Figure 3. 42-pin SDIP package pinout. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Figure 4. 32-pin LQFP package pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Figure 5. 32-pin SDIP package pinout. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Figure 6. Memory map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Figure 7. Memory map and sector address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Figure 8. Typical ICC interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Figure 9. CPU registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Figure 10. Stack manipulation example. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Figure 11. PLL block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Figure 12. Clock, reset and supply block diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Figure 13. Reset sequence phases. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Figure 14. Reset block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Figure 15. RESET sequences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Figure 16. Low voltage detector vs reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Figure 17. Using the AVD to monitor V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 DD Figure 18. Interrupt processing flowchart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Figure 19. Priority decision process flowchart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Figure 20. Concurrent interrupt management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Figure 21. Nested interrupt management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Figure 22. External interrupt control bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Figure 23. Power saving mode transitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Figure 24. Slow mode clock transitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Figure 25. Wait mode flowchart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Figure 26. Active-halt timing overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Figure 27. Active-halt mode flowchart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Figure 28. Halt timing overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Figure 29. Halt mode flowchart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Figure 30. I/O port general block diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Figure 31. Interrupt I/O port state transitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Figure 32. Watchdog block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Figure 33. Approximate timeout duration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 Figure 34. Exact timeout duration (t and t ). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 min max Figure 35. Main clock controller (MCC/RTC) block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 Figure 36. Timer block diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Figure 37. 16-bit read sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Figure 38. Counter timing diagram, internal clock divided by 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Figure 39. Counter timing diagram, internal clock divided by 4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Figure 40. Counter timing diagram, internal clock divided by 8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Figure 41. Input capture block diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Figure 42. Input capture timing diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Figure 43. Output compare block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Figure 44. Output compare timing diagram, f =f /2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 TIMER CPU Figure 45. Output compare timing diagram, f =f /4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 TIMER CPU Figure 46. One pulse mode cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Figure 47. One Pulse mode timing example(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Figure 48. Pulse width modulation mode timing example with two output compare functions(1)(2) . . 86 12/193

ST72324Bxx List of figures Figure 49. Pulse width modulation cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Figure 50. Serial peripheral interface block diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 Figure 51. Single master/single slave application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Figure 52. Generic SS timing diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Figure 53. Hardware/software slave select management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Figure 54. Data clock timing diagram(1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Figure 55. Clearing the WCOL bit (Write collision flag) software sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Figure 56. Single master/multiple slave configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Figure 57. SCI block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Figure 58. Word length programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Figure 59. SCI baud rate and extended prescaler block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Figure 60. Bit sampling in Reception mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Figure 61. ADC block diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Figure 62. Pin loading conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Figure 63. Pin input voltage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Figure 64. f max versus V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 CPU DD Figure 65. Typical application with an external clock source. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Figure 66. Typical application with a crystal or ceramic resonator (8/16Kbyte Flash and ROM devices) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 Figure 67. Typical application with a crystal or ceramic resonator (32Kbyte Flash and ROM devices) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Figure 68. Typical f vs T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 OSC(RCINT) A Figure 69. Integrated PLL jitter vs signal frequency(1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Figure 70. Unused I/O pins configured as input(1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Figure 71. Typical I vs. V with V = V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 PU DD IN SS Figure 72. Typical V at V =5 V (standard ports) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 OL DD Figure 73. Typical V at V = 5 V (high-sink ports) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 OL DD Figure 74. Typical V at V =5 V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 OH DD Figure 75. Typical V vs. V (standard ports) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 OL DD Figure 76. Typical V vs. V (high-sink ports). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 OL DD Figure 77. Typical V vs. V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 OH DD Figure 78. RESET pin protection when LVD is enabled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Figure 79. RESET pin protection when LVD is disabled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Figure 80. Two typical applications with ICCSEL/V pin(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 PP Figure 81. SPI slave timing diagram with CPHA=0(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Figure 82. SPI slave timing diagram with CPHA=1(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 Figure 83. SPI master timing diagram(1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 Figure 84. R max. vs f with C =0 pF(1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 AIN ADC AIN Figure 85. Recommended C and R values(1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 AIN AIN Figure 86. Typical A/D converter application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 Figure 87. Power supply filtering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Figure 88. ADC accuracy characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Figure 89. 44-pin low profile quad flat package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Figure 90. 42-pin plastic dual in-line package, shrink 600-mil width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Figure 91. 32-pin low profile quad flat package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Figure 92. 32-pin plastic dual in-line package, shrink 400-mil width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 Figure 93. ST72324Bxx ordering information scheme. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 13/193

Description ST72324Bxx 1 Description The ST72324Bxx devices are members of the ST7 microcontroller family designed for mid- range applications running from 3.8 to 5.5 V. Different package options offer up to 32 I/O pins. All devices are based on a common industry-standard 8-bit core, featuring an enhanced instruction set and are available with Flash or ROM program memory. The ST7 family architecture offers both power and flexibility to software developers, enabling the design of highly efficient and compact application code. The on-chip peripherals include an A/D converter, two general purpose timers, an SPI interface and an SCI interface. For power economy, the microcontroller can switch dynamically into, Slow, Wait, Active-halt or Halt mode when the application is in idle or stand-by state. Typical applications include consumer, home, office and industrial products. Figure 1. Device block diagram 8-bit CORE Program ALU memory (8 - 32Kbytes) RESET CONTROL V PP RAM V (384 - 1024bytes) SS V LVD DD WATCHDOG OSC1 OSC OSC2 A MCC/RTC/BEEP DD RE PORT A PA7:3 S (5 bits on J devices) PORT F S A (4 bits on K devices) PF7:6, 4, 2:0 N ((56 bbiittss oonn KJ ddeevviicceess)) TIMER A D DA TA PB4:0 BEEP BU PORT B (5 bits on J devices) S (3 bits on K devices) PORT E PE1:0 PORT C (2 bits) SCI TIMER B PC7:0 (8 bits) PORT D PD5:0 SPI (6 bits on J devices) (2 bits on K devices) 10-bit ADC V AREF V SSA 14/193

ST72324Bxx Pin description 2 Pin description Figure 2. 44-pin LQFP package pinout L E PE0/TDOV_DD2OSC1OSC2V_SS2RESETV/ICCSPPPA7 (HS)PA6 (HS) PA5 (HS)PA4 (HS) 4443424140393837363534 RDI / PE1 1 33 VSS_1 PB0 2 32 VDD_1 PB1 3 ei0 31 PA3 (HS) ei2 PB2 4 30 PC7/SS/AIN15 PB3 5 29 PC6/SCK/ICCCLK (HS) PB4 6 ei3 28 PC5/MOSI/AIN14 AIN0/PD0 7 27 PC4 / MISO/ICCDATA AIN1/PD1 8 26 PC3 (HS)/ICAP1_B AIN2/PD2 9 25 PC2 (HS)/ICAP2_B AIN3/PD3 10 ei1 24 PC1/OCMP1_B/AIN13 AIN4/PD4 11 23 PC0/OCMP2_B/AIN12 1213141516171819202122 5 F A012467 0 0 AIN5/PDVAREVSSMCO/AIN8/PFBEEP/(HS) PF(HS) PF1_A/AIN10/PFP1_A/(HS) PFLK_A/(HS) PFVDD_VSS_ PAC MCT CIX O E (HS) 20 mAhighsinkcapability eix associatedexternalinterruptvector Figure 3. 42-pin SDIP package pinout (HS) PB4 1 ei3 42 PB3 AIN0 / PD0 2 41 PB2 AIN1 / PD1 3 ei2 40 PB1 AIN2 / PD2 4 39 PB0 AIN3 / PD3 5 38 PE1 / RDI AIN4 / PD4 6 37 PE0 / TDO AIN5 / PD5 7 36 VDD_2 VAREF 8 35 OSC1 VSSA 9 34 OSC2 MCO / AIN8 / PF0 10 33 VSS_2 BEEP / (HS) PF1 11 ei1 32 RESET (HS) PF2 12 31 VPP / ICCSEL AIN10 / OCMP1_A / PF4 13 30 PA7 (HS) ICAP1_A / (HS) PF6 14 29 PA6 (HS) EXTCLK_A / (HS) PF7 15 28 PA5 (HS) AIN12 / OCMP2_B / PC0 16 27 PA4 (HS) AIN13 / OCMP1_B / PC1 17 26 VSS_1 ICAP2_B/ (HS) PC2 18 25 VDD_1 ICAP1_B / (HS) PC3 19 ei0 24 PA3 (HS) ICCDATA / MISO / PC4 20 23 PC7 / SS / AIN15 AIN14 / MOSI / PC5 21 22 PC6 / SCK / ICCCLK (HS) 20 mAhighsinkcapability eix associatedexternalinterruptvector 15/193

Pin description ST72324Bxx Figure 4. 32-pin LQFP package pinout 1/AIN10/AIN04 (HS)301/RDI0/TDO_D2 DDBBBEE D PPPPPPPV 3231302928272625 VAREF 1 ei3ei2 24 OSC1 VSSA 2 23 OSC2 MCO/AIN8/PF0 3 ei1 22 VSS_2 BEEP/(HS) PF1 4 21 RESET OCMP1_A/AIN10/PF4 5 20 VPP/ICCSEL ICAP1_A/(HS) PF6 6 19 PA7 (HS) EXTCLK_A/(HS) PF7 7 18 PA6 (HS) AIN12/OCMP2_B/PC0 8 ei0 17 PA4 (HS) 9 10111213141516 12345673 CCCCCCCA PPPPPPPP 13/OCMP1_B/CAP2_B/(HS) CAP1_B/(HS) CDATA/MISO/AIN14/MOSI/ICCCLK/SCK/AIN15/SS/ (HS) NIIC (HS) 20 mAhighsinkcapability AI I eix associatedexternalinterruptvector Figure 5. 32-pin SDIP package pinout (HS) PB4 1 ei3 32 PB3 AIN0 / PD0 2 ei2 31 PB0 AIN1 / PD1 3 30 PE1 / RDI VAREF 4 29 PE0 / TDO VSSA 5 28 VDD_2 MCO / AIN8 / PF0 6 27 OSC1 ei1 BEEP / (HS) PF1 7 26 OSC2 OCMP1_A / AIN10 / PF4 8 25 VSS_2 ICAP1_A / (HS) PF6 9 24 RESET EXTCLK_A / (HS) PF7 10 23 VPP / ICCSEL AIN12 / OCMP2_B / PC0 11 22 PA7 (HS) AIN13 / OCMP1_B / PC1 12 21 PA6 (HS) ICAP2_B / (HS) PC2 13 20 PA4 (HS) ICAP1_B / (HS) PC3 14 ei0 19 PA3 (HS) ICCDATA/ MISO / PC4 15 18 PC7 / SS / AIN15 AIN14 / MOSI / PC5 16 17 PC6 / SCK / ICCCLK (HS) 20mAhighsinkcapability eix associatedexternalinterruptvector See Section12: Electrical characteristics on page141 for external pin connection guidelines. Refer to Section9: I/O ports on page58 for more details on the software configuration of the I/O ports. The reset configuration of each pin is shown in bold. This configuration is valid as long as the device is in reset state. 16/193

ST72324Bxx Pin description Legend / Abbreviations for Table2: Type: I = input, O = output, S = supply Input level: A = Dedicated analog input In/Output level: C = CMOS 0.3V /0.7 DD DD C = CMOS 0.3V /0.7 with input trigger T DD DD Output level: HS = 20 mA high sink (on N-buffer only) Port and control configuration: Input: float = floating, wpu = weak pull-up, int = interrupt(a), ana = analog ports Output: OD = open drain(b), PP = push-pull Table 2. D evice pin description Pin No. Level Port Main e function LQFP44 SDIP42 LQFP32 SDIP32 Pin Name Typ Input Output float Iwpunpuintt ana OODutpPPut r(easfteetr) AlternateFunction 6 1 30 1 PB4 (HS) I/O C HS X ei3 X X Port B4 T 7 2 31 2 PD0/AIN0 I/O C X X X X X Port D0 ADC Analog Input 0 T 8 3 32 3 PD1/AIN1 I/O C X X X X X Port D1 ADC Analog Input 1 T 9 4 PD2/AIN2 I/O C X X X X X Port D2 ADC Analog Input 2 T 10 5 PD3/AIN3 I/O C X X X X X Port D3 ADC Analog Input 3 T 11 6 PD4/AIN4 I/O C X X X X X Port D4 ADC Analog Input 4 T 12 7 PD5/AIN5 I/O C X X X X X Port D5 ADC Analog Input 5 T 13 8 1 4 V (1) S Analog Reference Voltage for ADC AREF 14 9 2 5 V (1) S Analog Ground Voltage SSA ADC Main clock 15 10 3 6 PF0/MCO/AIN8 I/O C X ei1 X X X Port F0 Analog T out (f ) CPU Input 8 16 11 4 7 PF1 (HS)/BEEP I/O C HS X ei1 X X Port F1 Beep signal output T 17 12 PF2 (HS) I/O C HS X ei1 X X Port F2 T Timer A ADC PF4/OCMP1_A/ 18 13 5 8 I/O C X X X X X Port F4 Output Analog AIN10 T Compare 1 Input 10 PF6 19 14 6 9 I/O C HS X X X X Port F6 Timer A Input Capture 1 (HS)/ICAP1_A T PF7 (HS)/ Timer A External Clock 20 15 7 10 I/O C HS X X X X Port F7 EXTCLK_A T Source a. In the interrupt input column, “eiX” defines the associated external interrupt vector. If the weak pull-up column (wpu) is merged with the interrupt column (int), then the I/O configuration is pull-up interrupt input, else the configuration is floating interrupt input. b. In the open drain output column, ‘T’ defines a true open drain I/O (P-Buffer and protection diode to V are not DD implemented). See Section9: I/O ports and Section12.9: I/O port pin characteristics for more details. 17/193

Pin description ST72324Bxx Table 2. Device pin description (continued) Pin No. Level Port Main e function LQFP44 SDIP42 LQFP32 SDIP32 Pin Name Typ Input Output float Iwpunpuintt ana OODutpPPut r(easfteetr) AlternateFunction 21 V (1) S Digital Main Supply Voltage DD_0 22 V (1) S Digital Ground Voltage SS_0 Timer B ADC PC0/OCMP2_B 23 16 8 11 I/O C X X X X X Port C0 Output Analog /AIN12 T Compare 2 Input 12 Timer B ADC PC1/OCMP1_B 24 17 9 12 I/O C X X X X X Port C1 Output Analog /AIN13 T Compare 1 Input 13 PC2 (HS)/ 25 18 10 13 I/O C HS X X X X Port C2 Timer B Input Capture 2 ICAP2_B T PC3 (HS)/ 26 19 11 14 I/O C HS X X X X Port C3 Timer B Input Capture 1 ICAP1_B T SPI Master PC4/MISO/ICC ICC Data 27 20 12 15 I/O C X X X X Port C4 In / Slave DATA T Input Out Data SPI Master ADC PC5/MOSI/ 28 21 13 16 I/O C X X X X X Port C5 Out / Slave Analog AIN14 T In Data Input 14 PC6/SCK/ SPI Serial ICC Clock 29 22 14 17 I/O C X X X X Port C6 ICCCLK T Clock Output SPI Slave ADC 30 23 15 18 PC7/SS/AIN15 I/O C X X X X X Port C7 Select Analog T (active low) Input 15 ei 31 24 16 19 PA3 (HS) I/O C HS X X X Port A3 T 0 32 25 V (1) S Digital Main Supply Voltage DD_1 33 26 V (1) S Digital Ground Voltage SS_1 34 27 17 20 PA4 (HS) I/O C HS X X X X Port A4 T 35 28 PA5 (HS) I/O C HS X X X X Port A5 T 36 29 18 21 PA6 (HS) I/O C HS X T Port A6 (2) T 37 30 19 22 PA7 (HS) I/O C HS X T Port A7 (2) T Must be tied low. In the flash programming mode, this pin acts as the programming voltage input V . 38 31 20 23 V /ICCSEL I PP PP See Section12.10.2 for more details. High voltage must not be applied to ROM devices. 39 32 21 24 RESET I/O C Top priority non maskable interrupt. T 40 33 22 25 V (1) S Digital Ground Voltage SS_2 18/193

ST72324Bxx Pin description Table 2. Device pin description (continued) Pin No. Level Port Main e function LQFP44 SDIP42 LQFP32 SDIP32 Pin Name Typ Input Output float Iwpunpuintt ana OODutpPPut r(easfteetr) AlternateFunction 41 34 23 26 OSC2(3) O Resonator oscillator inverter output External clock input or Resonator 42 35 24 27 OSC1(3) I oscillator inverter input 43 36 25 28 V (1) S Digital Main Supply Voltage DD_2 44 37 26 29 PE0/TDO I/O C X X X X Port E0 SCI Transmit Data Out T 1 38 27 30 PE1/RDI I/O C X X X X Port E1 SCI Receive Data In T Caution: Negative current 2 39 28 31 PB0 I/O C X ei2 X X Port B0 injection not allowed on T this pin(4) 3 40 PB1 I/O C X ei2 X X Port B1 T 4 41 PB2 I/O C X ei2 X X Port B2 T ei 5 42 29 32 PB3 I/O C X X X Port B3 T 2 1. It is mandatory to connect all available V and V pins to the supply voltage and all V and V pins to ground. DD REF SS SSA 2. On the chip, each I/O port has eight pads. Pads that are not bonded to external pins are in input pull-up configuration after reset. The configuration of these pads must be kept at reset state to avoid added current consumption. 3. OSC1 and OSC2 pins connect a crystal/ceramic resonator, or an external source to the on-chip oscillator; see Section1: Description and Section12.6: Clock and timing characteristics for more details. 4. For details refer to Section12.9.1 on page 158 19/193

Register and memory map ST72324Bxx 3 Register and memory map As shown in Figure6, the MCU is capable of addressing 64 Kbytes of memories and I/O registers. The available memory locations consist of 128 bytes of register locations, up to 1024 bytes of RAM and up to 32 Kbytes of user program memory. The RAM space includes up to 256 bytes for the stack from 0100h to 01FFh. The highest address bytes contain the user reset and interrupt vectors. Caution: Never access memory locations marked as ‘Reserved’. Accessing a reserved area can have unpredictable effects on the device. Figure 6. Memory map 0000h 0080h HW registers Short addressing (see Table3) 007Fh RAM (zero page) 0080h 00FFh 0100h RAM 256bytesstack (1024, 512 or 384bytes) 01FFh 0200h 047Fh 16-bit addressing 0480h RAM Reserved 7FFFh 027Fh 8000h or047Fh 8000h Program memory 32 Kbytes (32, 16 or 8 Kbytes) C000h FFDFh 16 Kbytes FFE0h E000h Interrupt and reset vectors 8 Kbytes (see Table25) FFFFh FFFFh T able 3. Hardware register map Address Block Register label Register name Reset status Remarks 0000h PADR Port A data register 00h(2) R/W 0001h Port A(1) PADDR Port A data direction register 00h R/W 0002h PAOR Port A option register 00h R/W 0003h PBDR Port B data register 00h(2) R/W 0004h Port B(1) PBDDR Port B data direction register 00h R/W 0005h PBOR Port B option register 00h R/W 0006h PCDR Port C data register 00h(2) R/W 0007h Port C PCDDR Port C data direction register 00h R/W 0008h PCOR Port C option register 00h R/W 0009h PDADR Port D data register 00h(2) R/W 000Ah Port D(1) PDDDR Port D data direction register 00h R/W 000Bh PDOR Port D option register 00h R/W 000Ch PEDR Port E data register 00h(2) R/W 000Dh Port E(1) PEDDR Port E data direction register 00h R/W(1) 000Eh PEOR Port E option register 00h R/W(1) 20/193

ST72324Bxx Register and memory map Table 3. Hardware register map (continued) Address Block Register label Register name Reset status Remarks 000Fh PFDR Port F data register 00h(2) R/W 0010h Port F(1) PFDDR Port F data direction register 00h R/W 0011h PFOR Port F option register 00h R/W 0012h to Reserved area (15 bytes) 0020h 0021h SPIDR SPI data I/O register xxh R/W 0022h SPI SPICR SPI control register 0xh R/W 0023h SPICSR SPI control/status register 00h R/W 0024h ISPR0 Interrupt software priority register 0 FFh R/W 0025h ISPR1 Interrupt software priority register 1 FFh R/W 0026h ITC ISPR2 Interrupt software priority register 2 FFh R/W 0027h ISPR3 Interrupt software priority register 3 FFh R/W 0028h EICR External interrupt control register 00h R/W 0029h Flash FCSR Flash control/status register 00h R/W 002Ah Watchdog WDGCR Watchdog control register 7Fh R/W 002Bh SI SICSR System integrity control/status register 000x 000xb R/W 002Ch MCCSR Main clock control/status register 00h R/W MCC 002Dh MCCBCR Main clock controller: beep control register 00h R/W 002Eh to Reserved area (3 bytes) 0030h 0031h TACR2 Timer A control register 2 00h R/W 0032h TACR1 Timer A control register 1 00h R/W 0033h TACSR Timer A control/status register xxxx x0xxb R/W 0034h TAIC1HR Timer A input capture 1 high register xxh Read only 0035h TAIC1LR Timer A input capture 1 low register xxh Read only 0036h TAOC1HR Timer A output compare 1 high register 80h R/W 0037h TAOC1LR Timer A output compare 1 low register 00h R/W 0038h Timer A TACHR Timer A counter high register FFh Read only 0039h TACLR Timer A counter low register FCh Read only 003Ah TAACHR Timer A alternate counter high register FFh Read only 003Bh TAACLR Timer A alternate counter low register FCh Read only 003Ch TAIC2HR Timer A input capture 2 high register xxh Read only 003Dh TAIC2LR Timer A input capture 2 low register xxh Read only 003Eh TAOC2HR Timer A output compare 2 high register 80h R/W 003Fh TAOC2LR Timer A output compare 2 low register 00h R/W 0040h Reserved area (1 byte) 21/193

Register and memory map ST72324Bxx Table 3. Hardware register map (continued) Address Block Register label Register name Reset status Remarks 0041h TBCR2 Timer B control register 2 00h R/W 0042h TBCR1 Timer B control register 1 00h R/W 0043h TBCSR Timer B control/status register xxxx x0xxb R/W 0044h TBIC1HR Timer B input capture 1 high register xxh Read only 0045h TBIC1LR Timer B input capture 1 low register xxh Read only 0046h TBOC1HR Timer B output compare 1 high register 80h R/W 0047h TBOC1LR Timer B output compare 1 low register 00h R/W 0048h Timer B TBCHR Timer B counter high register FFh Read only 0049h TBCLR Timer B counter low register FCh Read only 004Ah TBACHR Timer B alternate counter high register FFh Read only 004Bh TBACLR Timer B alternate counter low register FCh Read only 004Ch TBIC2HR Timer B input capture 2 high register xxh Read only 004Dh TBIC2LR Timer B input capture 2 low register xxh Read only 004Eh TBOC2HR Timer B output compare 2 high register 80h R/W 004Fh TBOC2LR Timer B output compare 2 low register 00h R/W 0050h SCISR SCI status register C0h Read only 0051h SCIDR SCI data register xxh R/W 0052h SCIBRR SCI baud rate register 00h R/W 0053h SCICR1 SCI control register 1 x000 0000b R/W SCI 0054h SCICR2 SCI control register 2 00h R/W 0055h SCIERPR SCI extended receive prescaler register 00h R/W 0056h Reserved area --- 0057h SCIETPR SCI extended transmit prescaler register 00h R/W 0058h to Reserved area (24 bytes) 006Fh 0070h ADCCSR Control/status register 00h R/W 0071h ADC ADCDRH Data high register 00h Read only 0072h ADCDRL Data low register 00h Read only 0073h Reserved area (13 bytes) 007Fh 1. The bits associated with unavailable pins must always keep their reset value. 2. The contents of the I/O port DR registers are readable only in output configuration. In input configuration, the values of the I/O pins are returned instead of the DR register contents. Legend: x=undefined, R/W=read/write 22/193

ST72324Bxx Flash program memory 4 Flash program memory 4.1 Introduction The ST7 dual voltage High Density Flash (HDFlash) is a non-volatile memory that can be electrically erased as a single block or by individual sectors and programmed on a byte-by- byte basis using an external V supply. PP The HDFlash devices can be programmed and erased off-board (plugged in a programming tool) or on-board using ICP (in-circuit programming) or IAP (in-application programming). The array matrix organization allows each sector to be erased and reprogrammed without affecting other sectors. 4.2 Main features ● 3 Flash programming modes: – Insertion in a programming tool. In this mode, all sectors including option bytes can be programmed or erased. – ICP (in-circuit programming). In this mode, all sectors including option bytes can be programmed or erased without removing the device from the application board. – IAP (in-application programming). In this mode, all sectors, except Sector 0, can be programmed or erased without removing the device from the application board and while the application is running. ● ICT (in-circuit testing) for downloading and executing user application test patterns in RAM ● Readout protection ● Register Access Security System (RASS) to prevent accidental programming or erasing 4.3 Structure The Flash memory is organized in sectors and can be used for both code and data storage. Depending on the overall Flash memory size in the microcontroller device, there are up to three user sectors (seeTable4). Each of these sectors can be erased independently to avoid unnecessary erasing of the whole Flash memory when only a partial erasing is required. The first two sectors have a fixed size of 4 Kbytes (see Figure7). They are mapped in the upper part of the ST7 addressing space so the reset and interrupt vectors are located in Sector 0 (F000h-FFFFh). T able 4. Sectors available in Flash devices Flash size Available sectors 4 Kbytes Sector 0 8 Kbytes Sectors 0, 1 >8 Kbytes Sectors 0, 1, 2 23/193

Flash program memory ST72324Bxx 4.3.1 Readout protection Readout protection, when selected, provides a protection against program memory content extraction and against write access to Flash memory. Even if no protection can be considered as totally unbreakable, the feature provides a very high level of protection for a general purpose microcontroller. In Flash devices, this protection is removed by reprogramming the option. In this case, the entire program memory is first automatically erased. Readout protection selection depends on the device type: ● In Flash devices it is enabled and removed through the FMP_R bit in the option byte. ● In ROM devices it is enabled by mask option specified in the option list. Figure 7. Memory map and sector address 8K 16K 32K Flash memorysize 7FFFh Sector2 BFFFh 8Kbytes 24Kbytes DFFFh 4Kbytes Sector1 EFFFh 4Kbytes Sector0 FFFFh 24/193

ST72324Bxx Flash program memory 4.4 ICC interface ICC needs a minimum of 4 and up to 6 pins to be connected to the programming tool (see Figure8). These pins are: – RESET: device reset – V : device power supply ground SS – ICCCLK: ICC output serial clock pin – ICCDATA: ICC input/output serial data pin – ICCSEL/V : programming voltage PP – OSC1 (or OSCIN): main clock input for external source (optional) – V : application board power supply (optional, see Figure8, Note 3) DD Figure 8. Typical ICC interface Programming tool ICC connector Mandatory for 8/16Kbyte Flash devices ICC cable (see note 4) Application board (See note 3) ICC connector HE10connectortype 9 7 5 3 1 10 8 6 4 2 Application reset source See note 2 10 kΩ Application power supply See note 1 Application VDD OSC2 OSC1 ST7 VSS EL/VPP ESET CCLK DATA I/O S R C C C I C C I I 1. If the ICCCLK or ICCDATA pins are only used as outputs in the application, no signal isolation is necessary. As soon as the programming tool is plugged to the board, even if an ICC session is not in progress, the ICCCLK and ICCDATA pins are not available for the application. If they are used as inputs by the application, isolation such as a serial resistor has to be implemented in case another device forces the signal. Refer to the Programming Tool documentation for recommended resistor values. 2. During the ICC session, the programming tool must control the RESET pin. This can lead to conflicts between the programming tool and the application reset circuit if it drives more than 5mA at high level (PUSH-pull output or pull-up resistor <1 kΩ). A schottky diode can be used to isolate the application reset circuit in this case. When using a classical RC network with R>1kΩ or a reset management IC with open drain output and pull-up resistor >1 kΩ, no additional components are needed. In all cases the user must ensure that no external reset is generated by the application during the ICC session. 3. The use of Pin 7 of the ICC connector depends on the programming tool architecture. This pin must be connected when using most ST programming tools (it is used to monitor the application power supply). Please refer to the programming tool manual. 4. Pin 9 has to be connected to the OSC1 (OSCIN) pin of the ST7 when the clock is not available in the application or if the selected clock option is not programmed in the option byte. ST7 devices with multi- oscillator capability need to have OSC2 grounded in this case. Caution: External clock ICC entry mode is mandatory in ST72F324B 8/16Kbyte Flash devices. In this case pin 9 must be connected to the OSC1 (OSCIN) pin of the ST7 and OSC2 must be grounded. 32Kbyte Flash devices may use external clock or application clock ICC entry mode. 25/193

Flash program memory ST72324Bxx 4.5 ICP (in-circuit programming) To perform ICP the microcontroller must be switched to ICC (in-circuit communication) mode by an external controller or programming tool. Depending on the ICP code downloaded in RAM, Flash memory programming can be fully customized (number of bytes to program, program locations, or selection serial communication interface for downloading). When using an STMicroelectronics or third-party programming tool that supports ICP and the specific microcontroller device, the user needs only to implement the ICP hardware interface on the application board (see Figure8). For more details on the pin locations, refer to the device pinout description. 4.6 IAP (in-application programming) This mode uses a BootLoader program previously stored in Sector 0 by the user (in ICP mode or by plugging the device in a programming tool). This mode is fully controlled by user software. This allows it to be adapted to the user application, (such as user-defined strategy for entering programming mode, choice of communications protocol used to fetch the data to be stored). For example, it is possible to download code from the SPI, SCI, USB or CAN interface and program it in the Flash. IAP mode can be used to program any of the Flash sectors except Sector 0, which is write/erase protected to allow recovery in case errors occur during the programming operation. 4.7 Related documentation For details on Flash programming and ICC protocol, refer to the ST7 Flash Programming Reference Manual and to the ST7 ICC Protocol Reference Manual. 4.7.1 Flash Control/Status Register (FCSR) This register is reserved for use by programming tool software. It controls the Flash programming and erasing operations. FCSR Reset value:0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W T able 5. Flash control/status register address and reset value Address (Hex) Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0029h FCSR reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 26/193

ST72324Bxx Central processing unit (CPU) 5 Central processing unit (CPU) 5.1 Introduction This CPU has a full 8-bit architecture and contains six internal registers allowing efficient 8- bit data manipulation. 5.2 Main features ● Enable executing 63 basic instructions ● Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply ● 17 main addressing modes (with indirect addressing mode) ● Two 8-bit index registers ● 16-bit stack pointer ● Low power Halt and Wait modes ● Priority maskable hardware interrupts ● Non-maskable software/hardware interrupts 5.3 CPU registers The six CPU registers shown in Figure9 are not present in the memory mapping and are accessed by specific instructions. Figure 9. CPU registers 7 0 Accumulator Reset value = XXh 7 0 X index register Reset value = XXh 7 0 Y index register Reset value = XXh 15 PCH 8 7 PCL 0 Program counter Reset value = reset vector @ FFFEh-FFFFh 7 0 1 1 I1 H I0 N Z C Condition code register Reset value =1 1 1 X 1 X X X 15 8 7 0 Stack pointer Reset value = stack higher address X = undefined value 27/193

Central processing unit (CPU) ST72324Bxx 5.3.1 Accumulator (A) The Accumulator is an 8-bit general purpose register used to hold operands and the results of the arithmetic and logic calculations and to manipulate data. 5.3.2 Index registers (X and Y) These 8-bit registers are used to create effective addresses or as temporary storage areas for data manipulation. (The Cross-Assembler generates a precede instruction (PRE) to indicate that the following instruction refers to the Y register.) The Y register is not affected by the interrupt automatic procedures. 5.3.3 Program counter (PC) The program counter is a 16-bit register containing the address of the next instruction to be executed by the CPU. It is made of two 8-bit registers PCL (Program Counter Low which is the LSB) and PCH (Program Counter High which is the MSB). 5.3.4 Condition Code register (CC) The 8-bit Condition Code register contains the interrupt masks and four flags representative of the result of the instruction just executed. This register can also be handled by the PUSH and POP instructions. These bits can be individually tested and/or controlled by specific instructions. CC Reset value: 111x1xxx 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 I1 H I0 N Z C R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W T able 6. Arithmetic management bits BIt Name Function Half carry This bit is set by hardware when a carry occurs between bits 3 and 4 of the ALU during an ADD or ADC instructions. It is reset by hardware during the same instructions. 4 H 0: No half carry has occurred. 1: A half carry has occurred. This bit is tested using the JRH or JRNH instruction. The H bit is useful in BCD arithmetic subroutines. Negative This bit is set and cleared by hardware. It is representative of the result sign of the last arithmetic, logical or data manipulation. It is a copy of the result 7th bit. 2 N 0: The result of the last operation is positive or null. 1: The result of the last operation is negative (that is, the most significant bit is a logic 1. This bit is accessed by the JRMI and JRPL instructions. 28/193

ST72324Bxx Central processing unit (CPU) Table 6. Arithmetic management bits (continued) BIt Name Function Zero (Arithmetic Management bit) This bit is set and cleared by hardware. This bit indicates that the result of the last arithmetic, logical or data manipulation is zero. 1 Z 0: The result of the last operation is different from zero. 1: The result of the last operation is zero. This bit is accessed by the JREQ and JRNE test instructions. Carry/borrow This bit is set and cleared by hardware and software. It indicates an overflow or an underflow has occurred during the last arithmetic operation. 0 C 0: No overflow or underflow has occurred. 1: An overflow or underflow has occurred. This bit is driven by the SCF and RCF instructions and tested by the JRC and JRNC instructions. It is also affected by the ‘bit test and branch’, shift and rotate instructions. T able 7. Software interrupt bits BIt Name Function Software Interrupt Priority 1 5 I1 The combination of the I1 and I0 bits determines the current interrupt software priority (see Table8). Software Interrupt Priority 0 3 I0 The combination of the I1 and I0 bits determines the current interrupt software priority (see Table8). T able 8. Interrupt software priority selection Interrupt software priority Level I1 I0 Level 0 (main) Low 1 0 Level 1 0 1 Level 2 0 0 Level 3 (= interrupt disable) High 1 1 These two bits are set/cleared by hardware when entering in interrupt. The loaded value is given by the corresponding bits in the interrupt software priority registers (ISPRx). They can be also set/cleared by software with the RIM, SIM, IRET, HALT, WFI and PUSH/POP instructions. See Section7: Interrupts on page41 for more details. 29/193

Central processing unit (CPU) ST72324Bxx 5.3.5 Stack Pointer register (SP) SP Reset value: 01 FFh 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 SP7 SP6 SP5 SP4 SP3 SP2 SP1 SP0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W The Stack Pointer is a 16-bit register which is always pointing to the next free location in the stack. It is then decremented after data has been pushed onto the stack and incremented before data is popped from the stack (see Figure10). Since the stack is 256 bytes deep, the 8 most significant bits are forced by hardware. Following an MCU reset, or after a Reset Stack Pointer instruction (RSP), the Stack Pointer contains its reset value (the SP7 to SP0 bits are set) which is the stack higher address. The least significant byte of the Stack Pointer (called S) can be directly accessed by an LD instruction. Note: When the lower limit is exceeded, the Stack Pointer wraps around to the stack upper limit, without indicating the stack overflow. The previously stored information is then overwritten and therefore lost. The stack also wraps in case of an underflow. The stack is used to save the return address during a subroutine call and the CPU context during an interrupt. The user may also directly manipulate the stack by means of the PUSH and POP instructions. In the case of an interrupt, the PCL is stored at the first location pointed to by the SP. Then the other registers are stored in the next locations as shown in Figure10. ● When an interrupt is received, the SP is decremented and the context is pushed on the stack. ● On return from interrupt, the SP is incremented and the context is popped from the stack. A subroutine call occupies two locations and an interrupt five locations in the stack area. Figure 10. Stack manipulation example Call Interrupt Push Y Pop Y IRET RET subroutine event or RSP @ 0100h SP SP SP Y CC CC CC A A A X X X PCH PCH PCH SP SP PCL PCL PCL PCH PCH PCH PCH PCH SP @ 01FFh PCL PCL PCL PCL PCL Stack Higher Address = 01FFh Stack Lower Address = 0100h 30/193

ST72324Bxx Supply, reset and clock management 6 Supply, reset and clock management 6.1 Introduction The device includes a range of utility features for securing the application in critical situations (for example in case of a power brown-out), and reducing the number of external components. An overview is shown in Figure12. For more details, refer to dedicated parametric section. Main features ● Optional Phase Locked Loop (PLL) for multiplying the frequency by 2 (not to be used with internal RC oscillator in order to respect the max. operating frequency) ● Multi-Oscillator clock management (MO) – 5 crystal/ceramic resonator oscillators – 1 Internal RC oscillator ● Reset Sequence Manager (RSM) ● System Integrity management (SI) – Main supply low voltage detection (LVD) – Auxiliary voltage detector (AVD) with interrupt capability for monitoring the main supply 6.2 PLL (phase locked loop) If the clock frequency input to the PLL is in the range 2 to 4 MHz, the PLL can be used to multiply the frequency by two to obtain an f of 4 to 8 MHz. The PLL is enabled by option OSC2 byte. If the PLL is disabled, then f = f /2. OSC2 OSC Caution: The PLL is not recommended for applications where timing accuracy is required. Furthermore, it must not be used with the internal RC oscillator. Figure 11. PLL block diagram PLL x 2 0 f OSC f OSC2 / 2 1 PLL option bit 31/193

Supply, reset and clock management ST72324Bxx Figure 12. Clock, reset and supply block diagram OSC2 Multi- fOSC fOSC2 Main Clock fCPU PLL Controller oscillator OSC1 (MO) (option) Cwloicthk R(MeCalC-t/imRTeC ) System integritymanagement Resetsequence AVD interrupt request Watchdog RESET manager SICSR timer (WDG) (RSM) AVD AVD LVD WDG 0 0 0 0 IE F RF RF Low voltage VSS detector V (LVD) DD Auxiliaryvoltage detector (AVD) 6.3 Multi-oscillator (MO) The main clock of the ST7 can be generated by three different source types coming from the multi-oscillator block: ● an external source ● 4 crystal or ceramic resonator oscillators ● an internal high frequency RC oscillator Each oscillator is optimized for a given frequency range in terms of consumption and is selectable through the option byte. The associated hardware configurations are shown in Table9. Refer to the electrical characteristics section for more details. Caution: The OSC1 and/or OSC2 pins must not be left unconnected. For the purposes of Failure Mode and Effect Analysis, it should be noted that if the OSC1 and/or OSC2 pins are left unconnected, the ST7 main oscillator may start and, in this configuration, could generate an f clock frequency in excess of the allowed maximum (>16MHz.), putting the ST7 in an OSC unsafe/undefined state. The product behavior must therefore be considered undefined when the OSC pins are left unconnected. 6.3.1 External clock source In this external clock mode, a clock signal (square, sinus or triangle) with ~50% duty cycle has to drive the OSC1 pin while the OSC2 pin is tied to ground. 32/193

ST72324Bxx Supply, reset and clock management 6.3.2 Crystal/ceramic oscillators This family of oscillators has the advantage of producing a very accurate rate on the main clock of the ST7. The selection within a list of four oscillators with different frequency ranges has to be done by option byte in order to reduce consumption (refer to Section14.1 on page 179 for more details on the frequency ranges). In this mode of the multi-oscillator, the resonator and the load capacitors have to be placed as close as possible to the oscillator pins in order to minimize output distortion and start-up stabilization time. The loading capacitance values must be adjusted according to the selected oscillator. These oscillators are not stopped during the reset phase to avoid losing time in the oscillator start-up phase. 6.3.3 Internal RC oscillator This oscillator allows a low cost solution for the main clock of the ST7 using only an internal resistor and capacitor. Internal RC oscillator mode has the drawback of a lower frequency accuracy and should not be used in applications that require accurate timing. In this mode, the two oscillator pins have to be tied to ground. In order not to exceed the maximum operating frequency, the internal RC oscillator must not be used with the PLL. T able 9. ST7 clock sources Hardwareconfiguration k ST7 c clo OSC1 OSC2 al n r e xt External E source s or nat ST7 o s OSC1 OSC2 e r c mi a er c C C al/ L1 Load L2 st capacitors y Cr r o at ST7 scill OSC1 OSC2 o C R al n er nt I 33/193

Supply, reset and clock management ST72324Bxx 6.4 Reset sequence manager (RSM) The reset sequence manager includes three reset sources as shown in Figure14: ● External reset source pulse ● Internal LVD reset ● Internal Watchdog reset These sources act on the RESET pin and it is always kept low during the delay phase. The reset service routine vector is fixed at addresses FFFEh-FFFFh in the ST7 memory map. The basic reset sequence consists of three phases as shown in Figure13: ● Active Phase depending on the reset source ● 256 or 4096 CPU clock cycle delay (selected by option byte) ● Reset vector fetch Caution: When the ST7 is unprogrammed or fully erased, the Flash is blank and the RESET vector is not programmed. For this reason, it is recommended to keep the RESET pin in low state until programming mode is entered, in order to avoid unwanted behavior. The 256 or 4096 CPU clock cycle delay allows the oscillator to stabilize and ensures that recovery has taken place from the reset state. The shorter or longer clock cycle delay should be selected by option byte to correspond to the stabilization time of the external oscillator used in the application. The reset vector fetch phase duration is two clock cycles. Figure 13. Reset sequence phases RESET INTERNAL RESET FETCH ACTIVE PHASE 256 or 4096 CLOCK CYCLES VECTOR 6.4.1 Asynchronous external RESET pin The RESET pin is both an input and an open-drain output with integrated R weak pull-up ON resistor. This pull-up has no fixed value but varies in accordance with the input voltage. It can be pulled low by external circuitry to reset the device. See the Electrical characteristics section for more details. A reset signal originating from an external source must have a duration of at least t h(RSTL)in in order to be recognized (see Figure15). This detection is asynchronous and therefore the MCU can enter reset state even in Halt mode. 34/193

ST72324Bxx Supply, reset and clock management Figure 14. Reset block diagram VDD RON Internal RESET Filter reset Pulse Watchdogreset generator LVDreset The RESET pin is an asynchronous signal which plays a major role in EMS performance. In a noisy environment, it is recommended to follow the guidelines mentioned in the electrical characteristics section. External power-on reset If the LVD is disabled by option byte, to start up the microcontroller correctly, the user must ensure by means of an external reset circuit that the reset signal is held low until V is over DD the minimum level specified for the selected f frequency. OSC A proper reset signal for a slow rising V supply can generally be provided by an external DD RC network connected to the RESET pin. Internal LVD reset Two different reset sequences caused by the internal LVD circuitry can be distinguished: ● Power-On reset ● Voltage Drop reset The device RESET pin acts as an output that is pulled low when V <V (rising edge) or DD IT+ V <V (falling edge) as shown in Figure15. DD IT- The LVD filters spikes on V larger than t to avoid parasitic resets. DD g(VDD) Internal Watchdog reset The reset sequence generated by a internal Watchdog counter overflow is shown in Figure15. Starting from the Watchdog counter underflow, the device RESET pin acts as an output that is pulled low during at least t . w(RSTL)out 35/193

Supply, reset and clock management ST72324Bxx Figure 15. RESET sequences V DD V IT+(LVD) V IT-(LVD) LVD External Watchdog reset reset reset Run Run Run Run Active Active Active phase phase phase th(RSTL)in tw(RSTL)out External RESET source RESETpin Watchdog reset Watchdogunderflow Internalreset(256 or 4096T ) CPU Vector fetch 6.5 System integrity management (SI) The system integrity management block contains the LVD and auxiliary voltage detector (AVD) functions. It is managed by the SICSR register. 6.5.1 LVD (low voltage detector) The LVD function generates a static reset when the V supply voltage is below a V DD IT- reference value. This means that it secures the power-up as well as the power-down keeping the ST7 in reset. The V reference value for a voltage drop is lower than the V reference value for power- IT- IT+ on in order to avoid a parasitic reset when the MCU starts running and sinks current on the supply (hysteresis). The LVD reset circuitry generates a reset when V is below: DD – V when V is rising IT+ DD – V when V is falling IT- DD The LVD function is illustrated in Figure15. The voltage threshold can be configured by option byte to be low, medium or high. 36/193

ST72324Bxx Supply, reset and clock management Provided the minimum V value (guaranteed for the oscillator frequency) is above V , the DD IT- MCU can only be in two modes: – under full software control – in static safe reset In these conditions, secure operation is always ensured for the application without the need for external reset hardware. During an LVD reset, the RESET pin is held low, thus permitting the MCU to reset other devices. Note: 1 The LVD allows the device to be used without any external reset circuitry. 2 If the medium or low thresholds are selected, the detection may occur outside the specified operating voltage range. Below 3.8 V, device operation is not guaranteed. 3 The LVD is an optional function which can be selected by option byte. 4 It is recommended to make sure that the V supply voltage rises monotonously when the DD device is exiting from reset, to ensure the application functions properly. Figure 16. Low voltage detector vs reset VDD Vhys VIT+ VIT- RESET 6.5.2 AVD (auxiliary voltage detector) The AVD is based on an analog comparison between a V and V reference IT-(AVD) IT+(AVD) value and the V main supply. The V reference value for falling voltage is lower than the DD IT- V reference value for rising voltage in order to avoid parasitic detection (hysteresis). IT+ The output of the AVD comparator is directly readable by the application software through a real-time status bit (AVDF) in the SICSR register. This bit is read only. Caution: The AVD function is active only if the LVD is enabled through the option byte (see Section14.1 on page 179). Monitoring the V main supply DD The AVD voltage threshold value is relative to the selected LVD threshold configured by option byte (see Section14.1 on page 179). If the AVD interrupt is enabled, an interrupt is generated when the voltage crosses the V or V threshold (AVDF bit toggles). IT+(AVD) IT-(AVD) In the case of a drop in voltage, the AVD interrupt acts as an early warning, allowing software to shut down safely before the LVD resets the microcontroller. See Figure17. 37/193

Supply, reset and clock management ST72324Bxx The interrupt on the rising edge is used to inform the application that the V warning state DD is over. If the voltage rise time t is less than 256 or 4096 CPU cycles (depending on the reset delay rv selected by option byte), no AVD interrupt will be generated when V is reached. IT+(AVD) If t is greater than 256 or 4096 cycles then: rv ● If the AVD interrupt is enabled before the V threshold is reached, then 2 AVD IT+(AVD) interrupts will be received: the first when the AVDIE bit is set, and the second when the threshold is reached. ● If the AVD interrupt is enabled after the V threshold is reached then only one IT+(AVD) AVD interrupt will occur. Figure 17. Using the AVD to monitor V DD VDD Early warning interrupt (power has dropped, MCU not not yet in reset) Vhyst VIT+(AVD) VIT-(AVD) VIT+(LVD) VIT-(LVD) trv Voltage rise time AVDF bit 0 1 Reset value 1 0 AVD Interrupt Request if AVDIE bit = 1 Interruptprocess Interruptprocess LVD RESET 6.5.3 Low power modes T able 10. Effect of low power modes on SI Mode Description Wait No effect on SI. AVD interrupt causes the device to exit from Wait mode. Halt The CRSR register is frozen. 6.5.4 Interrupts The AVD interrupt event generates an interrupt if the AVDIE bit is set and the interrupt mask in the CC register is reset (RIM instruction). T aM ble 11. AVD interrupt control/wakeup capability Interrupt event Event flag Enable control bit Exit from Wait Exit from Halt AVD event AVDF AVDIE Yes No 38/193

ST72324Bxx Supply, reset and clock management 6.6 SI registers 6.6.1 System integrity (SI) control/status register (SICSR) SICSR Reset value: 000x 000x (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Res AVDIE AVDF LVDRF Reserved WDGRF - R/W RO R/W - R/W T able 12. SICSR register description Bit Name Function 7 - Reserved, must be kept cleared Voltage detector interrupt enable This bit is set and cleared by software. It enables an interrupt to be generated when the AVDF flag changes (toggles). The pending interrupt information is 6 AVDIE automatically cleared when software enters the AVD interrupt routine 0: AVD interrupt disabled 1: AVD interrupt enabled Voltage detector flag This read-only bit is set and cleared by hardware. If the AVDIE bit is set, an interrupt request is generated when the AVDF bit changes value. Refer to 5 AVDF Figure17 and to Section6.5.2: AVD (auxiliary voltage detector) for additional details. 0: V over V threshold DD IT+(AVD) 1: V under V threshold DD IT-(AVD) LVD Reset flag This bit indicates that the last reset was generated by the LVD block. It is set by 4 LVDRF hardware (LVD reset) and cleared by software (writing zero). See WDGRF flag description for more details. When the LVD is disabled by option byte, the LVDRF bit value is undefined. 3:1 - Reserved, must be kept cleared Watchdog Reset flag This bit indicates that the last reset was generated by the Watchdog peripheral. It is 0 WDGRF set by hardware (watchdog reset) and cleared by software (writing zero) or an LVD reset (to ensure a stable cleared state of the WDGRF flag when CPU starts). Combined with the LVDRF information, the flag description is given in Table13. T able 13. Reset source flags Reset sources LVDRF WDGRF External RESET pin 0 0 Watchdog 0 1 LVD 1 X 39/193

Supply, reset and clock management ST72324Bxx Application notes The LVDRF flag is not cleared when another reset type occurs (external or watchdog); the LVDRF flag remains set to keep trace of the original failure. In this case, a watchdog reset can be detected by software while an external reset cannot. Caution: When the LVD is not activated with the associated option byte, the WDGRF flag can not be used in the application. 40/193

ST72324Bxx Interrupts 7 Interrupts 7.1 Introduction The ST7 enhanced interrupt management provides the following features: ● Hardware interrupts ● Software interrupt (TRAP) ● Nested or concurrent interrupt management with flexible interrupt priority and level management: – up to 4 software programmable nesting levels – up to 16 interrupt vectors fixed by hardware – 2 non-maskable events: reset, TRAP This interrupt management is based on: ● Bit 5 and bit 3 of the CPU CC register (I1:0) ● Interrupt software priority registers (ISPRx) ● Fixed interrupt vector addresses located at the high addresses of the memory map (FFE0h to FFFFh) sorted by hardware priority order This enhanced interrupt controller guarantees full upward compatibility with the standard (not nested) ST7 interrupt controller. 7.2 Masking and processing flow The interrupt masking is managed by the I1 and I0 bits of the CC register and the ISPRx registers which give the interrupt software priority level of each interrupt vector (see Table14). The processing flow is shown in Figure18. When an interrupt request has to be serviced: ● Normal processing is suspended at the end of the current instruction execution. ● The PC, X, A and CC registers are saved onto the stack. ● I1 and I0 bits of CC register are set according to the corresponding values in the ISPRx registers of the serviced interrupt vector. ● The PC is then loaded with the interrupt vector of the interrupt to service and the first instruction of the interrupt service routine is fetched (refer to Table25: Interrupt mapping for vector addresses). The interrupt service routine should end with the IRET instruction which causes the contents of the saved registers to be recovered from the stack. Note: As a consequence of the IRET instruction, the I1 and I0 bits will be restored from the stack and the program in the previous level will resume. 41/193

Interrupts ST72324Bxx T able 14. Interrupt software priority levels Interrupt software priority Level I1 I0 Level 0 (main) Low 1 0 Level 1 0 1 Level 2 0 0 Level 3 (= interrupt disable) High 1 1 Figure 18. Interrupt processing flowchart Pending Y Y Reset Interrupt TRAP Interrupt has the same or a N N lower software priority than current one I1:0 FInesttcruhc ntieoxnt sTtahyesinpteenrrduinpgt higherorityone Y “INRET” errupthasasoftwareprithancurrent nt I RESTOREPC,X,A,CC Execute fromstack instruction Stack PC, X, A, CC load I1:0 from interrupt SW reg. load PC from interrupt vector 7.2.1 Servicing pending interrupts As several interrupts can be pending at the same time, the interrupt to be taken into account is determined by the following two-step process: ● the highest software priority interrupt is serviced, ● if several interrupts have the same software priority then the interrupt with the highest hardware priority is serviced first. Figure19 describes this decision process. Figure 19. Priority decision process flowchart PENDING INTERRUPTS Same SOFTWARE Different PRIORITY HIGHEST SOFTWARE PRIORITY SERVICED HIGHEST HARDWARE PRIORITY SERVICED 42/193

ST72324Bxx Interrupts When an interrupt request is not serviced immediately, it is latched and then processed when its software priority combined with the hardware priority becomes the highest one. Note: 1 The hardware priority is exclusive while the software one is not. This allows the previous process to succeed with only one interrupt. 2 Reset and TRAP can be considered as having the highest software priority in the decision process. 7.2.2 Different interrupt vector sources Two interrupt source types are managed by the ST7 interrupt controller: the non-maskable type (reset, TRAP) and the maskable type (external or from internal peripherals). 7.2.3 Non-maskable sources These sources are processed regardless of the state of the I1 and I0 bits of the CC register (see Figure18). After stacking the PC, X, A and CC registers (except for reset), the corresponding vector is loaded in the PC register and the I1 and I0 bits of the CC are set to disable interrupts (level 3). These sources allow the processor to exit Halt mode. TRAP (non-maskable software interrupt) This software interrupt is serviced when the TRAP instruction is executed. It will be serviced according to the flowchart in Figure18. Reset The reset source has the highest priority in the ST7. This means that the first current routine has the highest software priority (level 3) and the highest hardware priority. See the reset chapter for more details. 7.2.4 Maskable sources Maskable interrupt vector sources can be serviced if the corresponding interrupt is enabled and if its own interrupt software priority (in ISPRx registers) is higher than the one currently being serviced (I1 and I0 in CC register). If any of these two conditions is false, the interrupt is latched and thus remains pending. External interrupts External interrupts allow the processor to Exit from Halt low power mode. External interrupt sensitivity is software selectable through the External Interrupt Control register (EICR). External interrupt triggered on edge will be latched and the interrupt request automatically cleared upon entering the interrupt service routine. If several input pins of a group connected to the same interrupt line are selected simultaneously, these will be logically ORed. Peripheral interrupts Usually the peripheral interrupts cause the MCU to Exit from Halt mode except those mentioned in Table25: Interrupt mapping. A peripheral interrupt occurs when a specific flag is set in the peripheral status registers and if the corresponding enable bit is set in the 43/193

Interrupts ST72324Bxx peripheral control register. The general sequence for clearing an interrupt is based on an access to the status register followed by a read or write to an associated register. Note: The clearing sequence resets the internal latch. A pending interrupt (that is, waiting to be serviced) is therefore lost if the clear sequence is executed. 7.3 Interrupts and low power modes All interrupts allow the processor to exit the Wait low power mode. On the contrary, only external and other specified interrupts allow the processor to exit from the Halt modes (see column Exit from Halt in Table25: Interrupt mapping). When several pending interrupts are present while exiting Halt mode, the first one serviced can only be an interrupt with Exit from Halt mode capability and it is selected through the same decision process shown in Figure19. Note: If an interrupt, that is not able to exit from Halt mode, is pending with the highest priority when exiting Halt mode, this interrupt is serviced after the first one serviced. 7.4 Concurrent and nested management Figure20 and Figure21 show two different interrupt management modes. The first is called concurrent mode and does not allow an interrupt to be interrupted, unlike the nested mode in Figure21. The interrupt hardware priority is given in order from the lowest to the highest as follows: MAIN, IT4, IT3, IT2, IT1, IT0. Software priority is given for each interrupt. Warning: A stack overflow may occur without notifying the software of the failure. Figure 20. Concurrent interrupt management P IT2 IT1 IT4 IT3 TRA IT0 Spleroviofetrwlityare I1 I0 TRAP 3 1 1 s e e priority IT1 IT1 IT0 33 11 11 =10byt war IT2 3 1 1 ack Hard IT3 3 1 1 edst RIM s U IT4 3 1 1 Main Main 3/0 11/10 10 44/193

ST72324Bxx Interrupts Figure 21. Nested interrupt management P Software 2 1 4 3 RA 0 priority I1 I0 IT IT IT IT T IT level TRAP 3 1 1 s ority IT0 3 1 1 byte pri IT1 IT1 2 0 0 20 e = Hardwar RIM IT2 IT3 IT2 13 01 11 edstack s IT4 IT4 3 1 1 U Main Main 3/0 11 / 10 10 7.5 Interrupt registers 7.5.1 CPU CC register interrupt bits CPU CC Reset value: 111x 1010(xAh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 1 I1 H I0 N Z C R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W T able 15. CPU CC register interrupt bits description Bit Name Function 5 I1 Software Interrupt Priority 1 3 I0 Software Interrupt Priority 0 T able 16. Interrupt software priority levels Interrupt software priority Level I1 I0 Level 0 (main) Low 1 0 Level 1 0 1 Level 2 0 0 Level 3 (= interrupt disable)(1) High 1 1 1. TRAP and RESET events can interrupt a level 3 program. These two bits indicate the current interrupt software priority (see Table16) and are set/cleared by hardware when entering in interrupt. The loaded value is given by the corresponding bits in the interrupt software priority registers (ISPRx). They can be also set/cleared by software with the RIM, SIM, HALT, WFI, IRET and PUSH/POP instructions (see Table18: Dedicated interrupt instruction set). 45/193

Interrupts ST72324Bxx 7.5.2 Interrupt software priority registers (ISPRx) ISPRx Reset value: 1111 1111 (FFh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ISPR0 I1_3 I0_3 I1_2 I0_2 I1_1 I0_1 I1_0 I0_0 ISPR1 I1_7 I0_7 I1_6 I0_6 I1_5 I0_5 I1_4 I0_4 ISPR2 I1_11 I0_11 I1_10 I0_10 I1_9 I0_9 I1_8 I0_8 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W ISPR3 1 1 1 1 I1_13 I0_13 I1_12 I0_12 RO RO RO RO R/W R/W R/W R/W These four registers contain the interrupt software priority of each interrupt vector. ● Each interrupt vector (except reset and TRAP) has corresponding bits in these registers where its own software priority is stored. This correspondence is shown in the following Table17. T able 17. ISPRx interrupt vector correspondence Vector address ISPRx bits FFFBh-FFFAh I1_0 and I0_0 bits FFF9h-FFF8h I1_1 and I0_1 bits ... ... FFE1h-FFE0h I1_13 and I0_13 bits ● Each I1_x and I0_x bit value in the ISPRx registers has the same meaning as the I1 and I0 bits in the CC register. ● Level 0 cannot be written (I1_x=1, I0_x=0). In this case, the previously stored value is kept (for example, previous value=CFh, write=64h, result=44h). The reset, and TRAP vectors have no software priorities. When one is serviced, the I1 and I0 bits of the CC register are both set. Caution: If the I1_x and I0_x bits are modified while the interrupt x is executed the following behavior has to be considered: If the interrupt x is still pending (new interrupt or flag not cleared) and the new software priority is higher than the previous one, the interrupt x is re-entered. Otherwise, the software priority stays unchanged up to the next interrupt request (after the IRET of the interrupt x). T able 18. Dedicated interrupt instruction set(1) Instruction New description Function/example I1 H I0 N Z C HALT Entering Halt mode 1 0 IRET Interrupt routine return POP CC, A, X, PC I1 H I0 N Z C JRM Jump if I1:0=11 (level 3) I1:0=11 ? JRNM Jump if I1:0<>11 I1:0<>11 ? 46/193

ST72324Bxx Interrupts Table 18. Dedicated interrupt instruction set(1) (continued) Instruction New description Function/example I1 H I0 N Z C POP CC POP CC from the Stack Mem => CC I1 H I0 N Z C RIM Enable interrupt (level 0 set) Load 10 in I1:0 of CC 1 0 SIM Disable interrupt (level 3 set) Load 11 in I1:0 of CC 1 1 TRAP Software TRAP Software NMI 1 1 WFI Wait for interrupt 1 0 1. During the execution of an interrupt routine, the HALT, POP CC, RIM, SIM and WFI instructions change the current software priority up to the next IRET instruction or one of the previously mentioned instructions. 47/193

Interrupts ST72324Bxx 7.6 External interrupts 7.6.1 I/O port interrupt sensitivity The external interrupt sensitivity is controlled by the IPA, IPB and ISxx bits of the EICR register (Figure22). This control allows up to four fully independent external interrupt source sensitivities. Each external interrupt source can be generated on four (or five) different events on the pin: ● Falling edge ● Rising edge ● Falling and rising edge ● Falling edge and low level ● Rising edge and high level (only for ei0 and ei2) To guarantee correct functionality, the sensitivity bits in the EICR register can be modified only when the I1 and I0 bits of the CC register are both set to 1 (level 3). This means that interrupts must be disabled before changing sensitivity. The pending interrupts are cleared by writing a different value in the ISx[1:0], IPA or IPB bits of the EICR. Figure 22. External interrupt control bits Port A3 interrupt EICR IS20 IS21 PAOR.3 PADDR.3 ei0 interrupt source Sensitivity PA3 control IPA BIT Port F [2:0] interrupts EICR IS20 IS21 PFOR.2 PFDDR.2 Sensitivity PF2 PF2 control PF1 ei1 interrupt source PF0 Port B [3:0] interrupts EICR IS10 IS11 PBOR.3 PBDDR.3 Sensitivity PB3 PB3 control PB2 ei2 interrupt source PB1 PB0 IPB BIT Port B4 interrupt EICR IS10 IS11 PBOR.4 PBDDR.4 Sensitivity ei3 interrupt source PB4 control 48/193

ST72324Bxx Interrupts 7.6.2 External interrupt control register (EICR) EICR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IS11 IS10 IPB IS21 IS20 IPA Reserved R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W - T able 19. EICR register description Bit Name Function ei2 and ei3 sensitivity The interrupt sensitivity, defined using the IS1[1:0] bits, is applied to the following external interrupts: 7:6 IS1[1:0] - ei2 for port B [3:0] (see Table20) - ei3 for port B4 (see Table21) Bits 7 and 6 can only be written when I1 and I0 of the CC register are both set to 1 (level 3). Interrupt Polarity (for port B) This bit is used to invert the sensitivity of port B [3:0] external interrupts. It can be set and cleared by software only when I1 and I0 of the CC register are both set to 1 5 IPB (level 3). 0: No sensitivity inversion 1: Sensitivity inversion ei0 and ei1 sensitivity The interrupt sensitivity, defined using the IS2[1:0] bits, is applied to the following external interrupts: 4:3 IS2[1:0] - ei0 for port A[3:0] (see Table22) - ei1 for port F[2:0] (see Table23) Bits 4 and 3 can only be written when I1 and I0 of the CC register are both set to 1 (level 3). Interrupt Polarity (for port A) This bit is used to invert the sensitivity of port A [3:0] external interrupts. It can be set and cleared by software only when I1 and I0 of the CC register are both set to 1 2 IPA (level 3). 0: No sensitivity inversion. 1: Sensitivity inversion. 1:0 - Reserved, must always be kept cleared T able 20. Interrupt sensitivity - ei2 External interrupt sensitivity IS11 IS10 IPB bit =0 IPB bit =1 0 0 Falling edge and low level Rising edge and high level 0 1 Rising edge only Falling edge only 1 0 Falling edge only Rising edge only 1 1 Rising and falling edge 49/193

Interrupts ST72324Bxx T able 21. Interrupt sensitivity - ei3 IS11 IS10 External interrupt sensitivity 0 0 Falling edge and low level 0 1 Rising edge only 1 0 Falling edge only 1 1 Rising and falling edge T able 22. Interrupt sensitivity - ei0 External interrupt sensitivity IS21 IS20 IPA bit =0 IPA bit =1 0 0 Falling edge and low level Rising edge and high level 0 1 Rising edge only Falling edge only 1 0 Falling edge only Rising edge only 1 1 Rising and falling edge T able 23. Interrupt sensitivity - ei1 IS21 IS20 External interrupt sensitivity 0 0 Falling edge and low level 0 1 Rising edge only 1 0 Falling edge only 1 1 Rising and falling edge T able 24. Nested interrupts register map and reset values Address (Hex.) Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ei1 ei0 MCC + SI 0024h ISPR0 I1_3 I0_3 I1_2 I0_2 I1_1 I0_1 reset value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 SPI ei3 ei2 0025h ISPR1 I1_7 I0_7 I1_6 I0_6 I1_5 I0_5 I1_4 I0_4 reset value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 AVD SCI Timer B Timer A 0026h ISPR2 I1_11 I0_11 I1_10 I0_10 I1_9 I0_9 I1_8 I0_8 reset value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 ISPR3 I1_13 I0_13 I1_12 I0_12 0027h reset value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 EICR IS11 IS10 IPB IS21 IS20 IPA 0028h reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 50/193

ST72324Bxx Interrupts T able 25. Interrupt mapping Source Register Priority Exit from No. Description Address vector block label order Halt/Active-halt Reset Reset yes FFFEh-FFFFh N/A TRAP Software interrupt no FFFCh-FFFDh 0 Not used FFFAh-FFFBh Main clock controller time base Higher 1 MCC/RTC MCCSR yes FFF8h-FFF9h interrupt priority 2 ei0 External interrupt port A3..0 yes FFF6h-FFF7h 3 ei1 External interrupt port F2..0 yes FFF4h-FFF5h N/A 4 ei2 External interrupt port B3..0 yes FFF2h-FFF3h 5 ei3 External interrupt port B7..4 yes FFF0h-FFF1h 6 Not used FFEEh-FFEFh 7 SPI SPI peripheral interrupts SPICSR yes FFECh-FFEDh 8 Timer A Timer A peripheral interrupts TASR no FFEAh-FFEBh 9 Timer B Timer B peripheral interrupts TBSR no FFE8h-FFE9h 10 SCI SCI peripheral interrupts SCISR Lower no FFE6h-FFE7h priority 11 AVD Auxiliary voltage detector interrupt SICSR no FFE4h-FFE5h 51/193

Power saving modes ST72324Bxx 8 Power saving modes 8.1 Introduction To give a large measure of flexibility to the application in terms of power consumption, four main power saving modes are implemented in the ST7 (see Figure23): Slow, Wait (Slow Wait), Active-halt and Halt. After a reset the normal operating mode is selected by default (Run mode). This mode drives the device (CPU and embedded peripherals) by means of a master clock which is based on the main oscillator frequency divided or multiplied by 2 (f ). OSC2 From Run mode, the different power saving modes may be selected by setting the relevant register bits or by calling the specific ST7 software instruction whose action depends on the oscillator status. Figure 23. Power saving mode transitions High Run Slow Wait SlowWait ActiveHalt Halt Low Powerconsumption 8.2 Slow mode This mode has two targets: ● To reduce power consumption by decreasing the internal clock in the device, ● To adapt the internal clock frequency (f ) to the available supply voltage. CPU Slow mode is controlled by three bits in the MCCSR register: the SMS bit which enables or disables Slow mode and two CPx bits which select the internal slow frequency (f ). CPU In this mode, the master clock frequency (f ) can be divided by 2, 4, 8 or 16. The CPU OSC2 and peripherals are clocked at this lower frequency (f ). CPU Note: Slow-Wait mode is activated when entering the Wait mode while the device is already in Slow mode. 52/193

ST72324Bxx Power saving modes Figure 24. Slow mode clock transitions fOSC2/2 fOSC2/4 fOSC2 fCPU fOSC2 R CP1:0 00 01 S C C SMS M NormalRunmoderequest NewSlow frequency request 8.3 Wait mode Wait mode places the MCU in a low power consumption mode by stopping the CPU. This power saving mode is selected by calling the ‘WFI’ instruction. All peripherals remain active. During Wait mode, the I[1:0] bits of the CC register are forced to ‘10’, to enable all interrupts. All other registers and memory remain unchanged. The MCU remains in Wait mode until an interrupt or reset occurs, whereupon the Program Counter branches to the starting address of the interrupt or reset service routine. The MCU will remain in Wait mode until a reset or an interrupt occurs, causing it to wake up. Refer to Figure25. Figure 25. Wait mode flowchart Oscillator on Peripherals on WFIinstruction CPU off I[1:0]bits 10 N Reset N Y Interrupt Y Oscillator on Peripherals off CPU on I[1:0]bits 10 256or4096CPUclock cycledelay Oscillator on Peripherals on CPU on I[1:0]bits XX(1) Fetchresetvector orserviceinterrupt 1. Before servicing an interrupt, the CC register is pushed on the stack. The I[1:0] bits of the CC register are set to the current software priority level of the interrupt routine and recovered when the CC register is popped. 53/193

Power saving modes ST72324Bxx 8.4 Active-halt and Halt modes Active-halt and Halt modes are the two lowest power consumption modes of the MCU. They are both entered by executing the ‘HALT’ instruction. The decision to enter either in Active- halt or Halt mode is given by the MCC/RTC interrupt enable flag (OIE bit in the MCCSR register). T able 26. MCC/RTC low power mode selection MCCSR OIEbit Power saving mode entered when HALT instruction is executed 0 Halt mode 1 Active-halt mode 8.4.1 Active-halt mode Active-halt mode is the lowest power consumption mode of the MCU with a real-time clock available. It is entered by executing the ‘HALT’ instruction when the OIE bit of the Main Clock Controller Status register (MCCSR) is set (see Section10.2: Main clock controller with real- time clock and beeper (MCC/RTC) on page69 for more details on the MCCSR register). The MCU can exit Active-halt mode on reception of either an MCC/RTC interrupt, a specific interrupt (see Table25: Interrupt mapping) or a reset. When exiting Active-halt mode by means of an interrupt, no 256 or 4096 CPU cycle delay occurs. The CPU resumes operation by servicing the interrupt or by fetching the reset vector which woke it up (see Figure27). When entering Active-halt mode, the I[1:0] bits in the CC register are forced to ‘10b’ to enable interrupts. Therefore, if an interrupt is pending, the MCU wakes up immediately. In Active-halt mode, only the main oscillator and its associated counter (MCC/RTC) are running to keep a wakeup time base. All other peripherals are not clocked except those which get their clock supply from another clock generator (such as external or auxiliary oscillator). The safeguard against staying locked in Active-halt mode is provided by the oscillator interrupt. Note: As soon as the interrupt capability of one of the oscillators is selected (MCCSR.OIE bit set), entering Active-halt mode while the Watchdog is active does not generate a reset. This means that the device cannot spend more than a defined delay in this power saving mode. Caution: When exiting Active-halt mode following an interrupt, OIE bit of MCCSR register must not be cleared before t after the interrupt occurs (t = 256 or 4096 t delay depending DELAY DELAY CPU on option byte). Otherwise, the ST7 enters Halt mode for the remaining t period. DELAY Figure 26. Active-halt timing overview Active 256or4096CPU Run Halt cycle delay(1) Run Reset or Halt instruction interrupt Fetch [MCCSR.OIE = 1] vector 1. This delay occurs only if the MCU exits Active-halt mode by means of a reset. 54/193

ST72324Bxx Power saving modes Figure 27. Active-halt mode flowchart Oscillator on Haltinstruction Peripherals(1) off (MCCSR.OIE = 1) CPU off I[1:0]bits 10 N Reset N Y Interrupt(2) Oscillator on Peripherals off Y CPU on I[1:0]bits XX(3) 256or4096CPUclock cycledelay Oscillator on Peripherals on CPU on I[1:0]bits XX(3) Fetchresetvector orserviceinterrupt 1. Peripheral clocked with an external clock source can still be active. 2. Only the MCC/RTC interrupt and some specific interrupts can exit the MCU from Active-halt mode (such as external interrupt). Refer to Table25: Interrupt mapping on page51 for more details. 3. Before servicing an interrupt, the CC register is pushed on the stack. The I[1:0] bits of the CC register are set to the current software priority level of the interrupt routine and restored when the CC register is popped. 8.4.2 Halt mode The Halt mode is the lowest power consumption mode of the MCU. It is entered by executing the ‘HALT’ instruction when the OIE bit of the Main Clock Controller Status register (MCCSR) is cleared (see Section10.2: Main clock controller with real-time clock and beeper (MCC/RTC) on page69 for more details on the MCCSR register). The MCU can exit Halt mode on reception of either a specific interrupt (see Table25: Interrupt mapping) or a reset. When exiting Halt mode by means of a reset or an interrupt, the oscillator is immediately turned on and the 256 or 4096 CPU cycle delay is used to stabilize the oscillator. After the start up delay, the CPU resumes operation by servicing the interrupt or by fetching the reset vector which woke it up (see Figure29). When entering Halt mode, the I[1:0] bits in the CC register are forced to ‘10b’ to enable interrupts. Therefore, if an interrupt is pending, the MCU wakes up immediately. In Halt mode, the main oscillator is turned off causing all internal processing to be stopped, including the operation of the on-chip peripherals. All peripherals are not clocked except the ones which get their clock supply from another clock generator (such as an external or auxiliary oscillator). The compatibility of Watchdog operation with Halt mode is configured by the “WDGHALT” option bit of the option byte. The HALT instruction when executed while the Watchdog system is enabled, can generate a Watchdog reset (see Section14.1 on page 179) for more details. 55/193

Power saving modes ST72324Bxx Figure 28. Halt timing overview 256 or 4096CPU Run Halt Run cycle delay Reset or Halt interrupt instruction Fetch [MCCSR.OIE = 0] vector Figure 29. Halt mode flowchart Haltinstruction (MCCSR.OIE = 0) Enable Watchdog WDGHALT(1) 0 Disable 1 Watchdog Oscillator off reset Peripherals(2) off CPU off I[1:0]bits 10 N Reset N Y Interrupt(3) Y Oscillator on Peripherals off CPU on I[1:0]bits XX(4) 256or4096CPUclock cycledelay Oscillator on Peripherals on CPU on I[1:0]bits XX(4) Fetchresetvector orserviceinterrupt 1. WDGHALT is an option bit. See Section14.1 on page 179 for more details. 2. Peripheral clocked with an external clock source can still be active. 3. Only some specific interrupts can exit the MCU from Halt mode (such as external interrupt). Refer to Table25: Interrupt mapping for more details. 4. Before servicing an interrupt, the CC register is pushed on the stack. The I[1:0] bits of the CC register are set to the current software priority level of the interrupt routine and recovered when the CC register is popped. 56/193

ST72324Bxx Power saving modes Halt mode recommendations ● Make sure that an external event is available to wake up the microcontroller from Halt mode. ● When using an external interrupt to wake up the microcontroller, reinitialize the corresponding I/O as “Input Pull-up with Interrupt” before executing the HALT instruction. The main reason for this is that the I/O may be wrongly configured due to external interference or by an unforeseen logical condition. ● For the same reason, reinitialize the sensitivity level of each external interrupt as a precautionary measure. ● The opcode for the HALT instruction is 0x8E. To avoid an unexpected HALT instruction due to a program counter failure, it is advised to clear all occurrences of the data value 0x8E from memory. For example, avoid defining a constant in ROM with the value 0x8E. ● As the HALT instruction clears the interrupt mask in the CC register to allow interrupts, the user may choose to clear all pending interrupt bits before executing the HALT instruction. This avoids entering other peripheral interrupt routines after executing the external interrupt routine corresponding to the wakeup event (reset or external interrupt). 57/193

I/O ports ST72324Bxx 9 I/O ports 9.1 Introduction The I/O ports offer different functional modes: ● transfer of data through digital inputs and outputs, and for specific pins: ● external interrupt generation, ● alternate signal input/output for the on-chip peripherals. An I/O port contains up to 8 pins. Each pin can be programmed independently as digital input (with or without interrupt generation) or digital output. 9.2 Functional description Each port has two main registers: ● Data Register (DR) ● Data Direction Register (DDR) and one optional register: ● Option Register (OR) Each I/O pin may be programmed using the corresponding register bits in the DDR and OR registers: bit X corresponding to pin X of the port. The same correspondence is used for the DR register. The following description takes into account the OR register, (for specific ports which do not provide this register refer to Section9.3: I/O port implementation on page62). The generic I/O block diagram is shown in Figure30. 9.2.1 Input modes The input configuration is selected by clearing the corresponding DDR register bit. In this case, reading the DR register returns the digital value applied to the external I/O pin. Different input modes can be selected by software through the OR register. Note: 1 Writing the DR register modifies the latch value but does not affect the pin status. 2 When switching from input to output mode, the DR register has to be written first to drive the correct level on the pin as soon as the port is configured as an output. 3 Do not use read/modify/write instructions (BSET or BRES) to modify the DR register as this might corrupt the DR content for I/Os configured as input. 58/193

ST72324Bxx I/O ports External interrupt function When an I/O is configured as ‘Input with Interrupt’, an event on this I/O can generate an external interrupt request to the CPU. Each pin can independently generate an interrupt request. The interrupt sensitivity is independently programmable using the sensitivity bits in the EICR register. Each external interrupt vector is linked to a dedicated group of I/O port pins (see pinout description and interrupt section). If several input pins are selected simultaneously as interrupt sources, these are first detected according to the sensitivity bits in the EICR register and then logically ORed. The external interrupts are hardware interrupts, which means that the request latch (not accessible directly by the application) is automatically cleared when the corresponding interrupt vector is fetched. To clear an unwanted pending interrupt by software, the sensitivity bits in the EICR register must be modified. 9.2.2 Output modes The output configuration is selected by setting the corresponding DDR register bit. In this case, writing the DR register applies this digital value to the I/O pin through the latch. Then reading the DR register returns the previously stored value. Two different output modes can be selected by software through the OR register: Output push-pull and open-drain. T able 27. DR register value and output pin status DR Push-pull Open-drain 0 V V SS SS 1 V Floating DD 9.2.3 Alternate functions When an on-chip peripheral is configured to use a pin, the alternate function is automatically selected. This alternate function takes priority over the standard I/O programming. When the signal is coming from an on-chip peripheral, the I/O pin is automatically configured in output mode (push-pull or open drain according to the peripheral). When the signal is going to an on-chip peripheral, the I/O pin must be configured in input mode. In this case, the pin state is also digitally readable by addressing the DR register. Note: Input pull-up configuration can cause unexpected value at the input of the alternate peripheral input. When an on-chip peripheral use a pin as input and output, this pin has to be configured in input floating mode. 59/193

I/O ports ST72324Bxx Figure 30. I/O port general block diagram Alternate Racecgeisstser output 1 VDD P-buffer (see table 24 below) 0 Alternate Pull-up enable (see table 24 below) DR VDD DDR Pull-up Pad condition OR D a ta If implemented b u s OR SEL N-buffer Diodes (see table 24 below) DDR SEL Analog input CMOS Schmitt DR SEL 1 trigger 0 Alternate input External interrupt source (eix) T able 28. I/O port mode options Diodes Configuration mode Pull-up P-buffer toV (1) toV (2) DD SS Floating with/without Interrupt Off(3) Input Off Pull-up with/without Interrupt On(4) On Push-pull On On Off Output Open drain (logic level) Off True open drain NI NI NI(5) 1. The diode to V is not implemented in the true open drain pads. DD 2. A local protection between the pad and V is implemented to protect the device against positive stress. SS 3. Off = implemented not activated. 4. On = implemented and activated. 5. NI = not implemented 60/193

ST72324Bxx I/O ports T able 29. I/O port configurations Hardwareconfiguration tNruoet iomppelenm deranitned in VDD DR register access I/O ports Pull-up RPU condition DR W register Data bus Pad R Alternate input External interrupt source (eix) Interrupt 1) condition (ut np Analog input I Not implemented in DR register access true open drain VDD I/O ports (2)ut RPU DR R/W utp Pad register Data bus o n ai dr - n Alternate Alternate pe enable output O Not implemented in DR register access tIr/Oue p ooprtesn drain VDD (2)ut RPU DR R/W Data bus p Pad register ut o ull p H- S Alternate Alternate U enable output P 1. When the I/O port is in input configuration and the associated alternate function is enabled as an output, reading the DR register will read the alternate function output status. 2. When the I/O port is in output configuration and the associated alternate function is enabled as an input, the alternate function reads the pin status given by the DR register content. Caution: The alternate function must not be activated as long as the pin is configured as input with interrupt, in order to avoid generating spurious interrupts. 61/193

I/O ports ST72324Bxx Analog alternate function When the pin is used as an ADC input, the I/O must be configured as floating input. The analog multiplexer (controlled by the ADC registers) switches the analog voltage present on the selected pin to the common analog rail which is connected to the ADC input. It is recommended not to change the voltage level or loading on any port pin while conversion is in progress. Furthermore it is recommended not to have clocking pins located close to a selected analog pin. Warning: The analog input voltage level must be within the limits stated in the absolute maximum ratings. 9.3 I/O port implementation The hardware implementation on each I/O port depends on the settings in the DDR and OR registers and specific feature of the I/O port such as ADC Input or true open drain. Switching these I/O ports from one state to another should be done in a sequence that prevents unwanted side effects. Recommended safe transitions are illustrated in Figure31. Other transitions are potentially risky and should be avoided, since they are likely to present unwanted side-effects such as spurious interrupt generation. Figure 31. Interrupt I/O port state transitions 01 00 10 11 Input Input Output Output floating/pull-up floating open-drain push-pull interrupt (reset state) XX = DDR, OR 9.4 Low power modes T able 30. Effect of low power modes on I/O ports Mode Description Wait No effect on I/O ports. External interrupts cause the device to exit from Wait mode. Halt No effect on I/O ports. External interrupts cause the device to exit from Halt mode. 9.5 Interrupts The external interrupt event generates an interrupt if the corresponding configuration is selected with DDR and OR registers and the interrupt mask in the CC register is not active (RIM instruction). 62/193

ST72324Bxx I/O ports T able 31. I/O port interrupt control/wakeup capability Interruptevent Event flag Enable Control bit Exit from Wait Exit from Halt External interrupt on selected - DDRx, ORx Yes Yes external event 9.5.1 I/O port implementation The I/O port register configurations are summarized Table32. T able 32. Port configuration Input (DDR=0) Output (DDR= 1) Port Pin name OR = 0 OR = 1 OR = 0 OR = 1 PA7:6 Floating True open-drain (high sink) Port A PA5:4 Floating Pull-up Open drain Push-pull PA3 Floating Floating interrupt Open drain Push-pull PB3 Floating Floating interrupt Open drain Push-pull Port B PB4, PB2:0 Floating Pull-up Open drain Push-pull Port C PC7:0 Floating Pull-up Open drain Push-pull Port D PD5:0 Floating Pull-up Open drain Push-pull Port E PE1:0 Floating Pull-up Open drain Push-pull PF7:6, 4 Floating Pull-up Open drain Push-pull Port F PF2:0 Floating Pull-up Open drain Push-pull T able 33. I/O port register map and reset values Address (Hex.) Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Reset value of all I/O port registers 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0000h PADR 0001h PADDR MSB LSB 0002h PAOR 0003h PBDR 0004h PBDDR MSB LSB 0005h PBOR 0006h PCDR 0007h PCDDR MSB LSB 0008h PCOR 0009h PDDR 000Ah PDDDR MSB LSB 000Bh PDOR 63/193

I/O ports ST72324Bxx Table 33. I/O port register map and reset values Address (Hex.) Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 000Ch PEDR 000Dh PEDDR MSB LSB 000Eh PEOR 000Fh PFDR 0010h PFDDR MSB LSB 0011h PFOR 64/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 10 On-chip peripherals 10.1 Watchdog timer (WDG) 10.1.1 Introduction The Watchdog timer is used to detect the occurrence of a software fault, usually generated by external interference or by unforeseen logical conditions, which causes the application program to abandon its normal sequence. The Watchdog circuit generates an MCU reset on expiry of a programmed time period, unless the program refreshes the counter’s contents before the T6 bit becomes cleared. 10.1.2 Main features ● Programmable free-running downcounter ● Programmable reset ● Reset (if Watchdog activated) when the T6 bit reaches zero ● Optional reset on HALT instruction (configurable by option byte) ● Hardware Watchdog selectable by option byte 10.1.3 Functional description The counter value stored in the Watchdog Control register (WDGCR bits T[6:0]), is decremented every 16384 f cycles (approx.), and the length of the timeout period can OSC2 be programmed by the user in 64 increments. If the watchdog is activated (the WDGA bit is set) and when the 7-bit timer (bits T[6:0]) rolls over from 40h to 3Fh (T6 becomes cleared), it initiates a reset cycle pulling low the reset pin for typically 30µs. The application program must write in the WDGCR register at regular intervals during normal operation to prevent an MCU reset. This downcounter is free-running: it counts down even if the watchdog is disabled. The value to be stored in the WDGCR register must be between FFh and C0h: ● The WDGA bit is set (Watchdog enabled) ● The T6 bit is set to prevent generating an immediate reset ● The T[5:0] bits contain the number of increments which represents the time delay before the Watchdog produces a reset (see Figure33: Approximate timeout duration). The timing varies between a minimum and a maximum value due to the unknown status of the prescaler when writing to the WDGCR register (see Figure34). Following a reset, the watchdog is disabled. Once activated it cannot be disabled, except by a reset. The T6 bit can be used to generate a software reset (the WDGA bit is set and the T6 bit is cleared). If the Watchdog is activated, the HALT instruction generates a reset. 65/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Figure 32. Watchdog block diagram Reset fOSC2 MCC/RTC Watchdog Control register (WDGCR) Div 64 WDGA T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0 6-bit downcounter (CNT) 12-bit MCC RTC counter WDG prescaler MSB LSB TB[1:0] bits div 4 (MCCSR 11 65 0 register) 10.1.4 How to program the Watchdog timeout Figure33 shows the linear relationship between the 6-bit value to be loaded in the Watchdog Counter (CNT) and the resulting timeout duration in milliseconds. This can be used for a quick calculation without taking the timing variations into account. If more precision is needed, use the formulae in Figure34. Caution: When writing to the WDGCR register, always write 1 in the T6 bit to avoid generating an immediate reset. Figure 33. Approximate timeout duration 3F 38 30 28 x.) e H 20 e ( u al v T 18 N C 10 08 00 1.5 18 34 50 65 82 98 114 128 Watchdog timeout (ms) @ 8 MHz. fOSC2 66/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Figure 34. Exact timeout duration (t and t ) min max WHERE: tmin0 = (LSB + 128) x 64 x tOSC2 tmax0 = 16384 x tOSC2 tOSC2 = 125 ns if fOSC2=8 MHz CNT = value of T[5:0] bits in the WDGCR register (6 bits) MSB and LSB are values from the table below depending on the timebase selected by the TB[1:0] bits in the MCCSR register TB1 bit TB0 bit Selected MCCSR timebase MSB LSB (MCCSR reg.) (MCCSR reg.) 0 0 2 ms 4 59 0 1 4 ms 8 53 1 0 10 ms 20 35 1 1 25 ms 49 54 To calculate the minimum Watchdog timeout (tmin): IFCNT< M------S----B--- THEN t = t +16384×CNT×t 4 min min0 osc2 ELSE tmin = tmin0+ 16384×⎝⎛CNT– 4--M--C---S--N---B--T--- ⎠⎞+(192+LSB)×64× 4--M--C----S-N---B--T--- ×tosc2 To calculate the maximum Watchdog timeout (tmax): IF CNT≤M------S----B--- THEN t = t +16384×CNT×t 4 max max0 osc2 ELSEtmax = tmax0+ 16384×⎝⎛CNT– 4--M--C----S-N---B--T--- ⎠⎞+(192+LSB)×64× 4--M--C---S--N---B--T--- ×tosc2 NOTE: In the above formulae, division results must be rounded down to the next integer value. EXAMPLE: With 2ms timeout selected in MCCSR register Value of T[5:0] bits in WDGCR register Min. Watchdog timeout (ms) Max. Watchdog timeout (ms) (Hex.) tmin tmax 00 1.496 2.048 3F 128 128.552 67/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx 10.1.5 Low power modes T able 34. Effect of lower power modes on Watchdog Mode Description Slow No effect on Watchdog Wait OIE bit in WDGHALT bit in MCCSR register option byte No Watchdog reset is generated. The MCU enters Halt mode. The Watchdog counter is decremented once and then stops counting and is no longer able to generate a watchdog reset until the MCU receives an external interrupt or a reset. 0 0 If an external interrupt is received, the Watchdog restarts counting after 256 or 4096 CPU clocks. If a reset is generated, the Watchdog is disabled (reset Halt state) unless Hardware Watchdog is selected by option byte. For application recommendations, see Section10.1.7 below. 0 1 A reset is generated. No reset is generated. The MCU enters Active-halt mode. The Watchdog counter is not decremented. It stop counting. When the MCU receives an oscillator 1 x interrupt or external interrupt, the Watchdog restarts counting immediately. When the MCU receives a reset the Watchdog restarts counting after 256 or 4096 CPU clocks. 10.1.6 Hardware Watchdog option If Hardware Watchdog is selected by option byte, the watchdog is always active and the WDGA bit in the WDGCR is not used. Refer to the option byte description in Section14.1: Flash devices. 10.1.7 Using Halt mode with the WDG (WDGHALT option) The following recommendation applies if Halt mode is used when the watchdog is enabled: Before executing the HALT instruction, refresh the WDG counter to avoid an unexpected WDG reset immediately after waking up the microcontroller. 10.1.8 Interrupts None. 68/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 10.1.9 Control register (WDGCR) WDGCR Reset value: 0111 1111 (7Fh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WDGA T[6:0] R/W R/W T able 35. WDGCR register description Bit Name Function Activation bit This bit is set by software and only cleared by hardware after a reset. When WDGA=1, the watchdog can generate a reset. 7 WDGA 0: Watchdog disabled 1: Watchdog enabled Note: This bit is not used if the hardware watchdog option is enabled by option byte. 7-bit counter (MSB to LSB) These bits contain the value of the Watchdog counter, which is decremented every 6:0 T[6:0] 16384 f cycles (approx.). A reset is produced when it rolls over from 40h to 3Fh OSC2 (T6 is cleared). T able 36. Watchdog timer register map and reset values Address (Hex.) Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WDGCR WDGA T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0 002Ah reset value 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 10.2 Main clock controller with real-time clock and beeper (MCC/RTC) The main clock controller consists of three different functions: ● a programmable CPU clock prescaler ● a clock-out signal to supply external devices ● a real-time clock timer with interrupt capability Each function can be used independently and simultaneously. 10.2.1 Programmable CPU clock prescaler The programmable CPU clock prescaler supplies the clock for the ST7 CPU and its internal peripherals. It manages Slow power saving mode (see Section8.2: Slow mode on page52 for more details). The prescaler selects the f main clock frequency and is controlled by three bits in the CPU MCCSR register: CP[1:0] and SMS. 69/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx 10.2.2 Clock-out capability The clock-out capability is an alternate function of an I/O port pin that outputs the f clock CPU to drive external devices. It is controlled by the MCO bit in the MCCSR register. Caution: When selected, the clock out pin suspends the clock during Active-halt mode. 10.2.3 Real-time clock (RTC) timer The counter of the real-time clock timer allows an interrupt to be generated based on an accurate real-time clock. Four different time bases depending directly on f are available. OSC2 The whole functionality is controlled by four bits of the MCCSR register: TB[1:0], OIE and OIF. When the RTC interrupt is enabled (OIE bit set), the ST7 enters Active-halt mode when the HALT instruction is executed. See Section8.4: Active-halt and Halt modes on page54 for more details. 10.2.4 Beeper The beep function is controlled by the MCCBCR register. It can output three selectable frequencies on the Beep pin (I/O port alternate function). Figure 35. Main clock controller (MCC/RTC) block diagram BC1 BC0 MCCBCR Beep Beep signal selection MCO 12-bit MCC RTC To Div 64 counter Watchdog timer MCO CP1 CP0 SMS TB1 TB0 OIE OIF MCCSR MCC/RTCinterrupt fOSC2 Div 2,4,8,16 1 fCPU CPU clock to CPU and 0 peripherals 70/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 10.2.5 Low power modes T able 37. Effect of low power modes on MCC/RTC Mode Description No effect on MCC/RTC peripheral. MCC/RTC interrupt causes the device to exit Wait from Wait mode. No effect on MCC/RTC counter (OIE bit is set), the registers are frozen. Active-halt MCC/RTC interrupt causes the device to exit from Active-halt mode. MCC/RTC counter and registers are frozen. MCC/RTC operation resumes when Halt the MCU is woken up by an interrupt with Exit from Halt capability. 10.2.6 Interrupts The MCC/RTC interrupt event generates an interrupt if the OIE bit of the MCCSR register is set and the interrupt mask in the CC register is not active (RIM instruction). T able 38. MCC/RTC interrupt control/wakeup capability Interruptevent Event flag Enable control bit Exit from Wait Exit from Halt Time base overflow event OIF OIE Yes No(1) 1. The MCC/RTC interrupt wakes up the MCU from Active-halt mode, not from Halt mode. 10.2.7 MCC registers MCC control/status register (MCCSR) ) MCCSR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MCO CP[1:0] SMS TB[1:0] OIE OIF R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W T able 39. MCCSR register description Bit Name Function Main Clock Out selection This bit enables the MCO alternate function on the PF0 I/O port. It is set and cleared by software. 7 MCO 0: MCO alternate function disabled (I/O pin free for general-purpose I/O). 1: MCO alternate function enabled (f on I/O port). CPU Note: To reduce power consumption, the MCO function is not active in Active-halt mode. 71/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Table 39. MCCSR register description (continued) Bit Name Function CPU Clock Prescaler These bits select the CPU clock prescaler which is applied in different slow modes. Their action is conditioned by the setting of the SMS bit. These two bits are set and cleared by software: 6:5 CP[1:0] 00: f in Slow mode=f /2 CPU OSC2 01: f in Slow mode=f /4 CPU OSC2 10: f in Slow mode=f /8 CPU OSC2 11: f in Slow mode=f /16 CPU OSC2 Slow Mode Select This bit is set and cleared by software. 0: Normal mode. f =f . 4 SMS CPU OSC2 1: Slow mode. f is given by CP1, CP0. CPU See Section8.2: Slow mode and Section10.2: Main clock controller with real-time clock and beeper (MCC/RTC) for more details. Time Base control These bits select the programmable divider time base. They are set and cleared by 3:2 TB[1:0] software (see Table40). A modification of the time base is taken into account at the end of the current period (previously set) to avoid an unwanted time shift. This allows to use this time base as a real-time clock. Oscillator interrupt Enable This bit set and cleared by software. 0: Oscillator interrupt disabled 1 OIE 1: Oscillator interrupt enabled This interrupt can be used to exit from Active-halt mode. When this bit is set, calling the ST7 software HALT instruction enters the Active-halt power saving mode . Oscillator interrupt Flag This bit is set by hardware and cleared by software reading the MCCSR register. It indicates when set that the main oscillator has reached the selected elapsed time (TB1:0). 0 OIF 0: Timeout not reached 1: Timeout reached Caution: The BRES and BSET instructions must not be used on the MCCSR register to avoid unintentionally clearing the OIF bit. T a. ble 40. Time base selection Time base Counter prescaler TB1 TB0 f =4MHz f =8MHz OSC2 OSC2 16000 4 ms 2 ms 0 0 32000 8 ms 4 ms 0 1 80000 20 ms 10 ms 1 0 200000 50 ms 25 ms 1 1 72/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals MCC beep control register (MCCBCR) MCCBCR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Reserved BC[1:0] - R/W T able 41. MCCBCR register description Bit Name Function 7:2 - Reserved, must be kept cleared Beep Control These 2 bits select the PF1 pin beep capability (see Table42). The beep output 1:0 BC[1:0] signal is available in Active-halt mode but has to be disabled to reduce the consumption. T able 42. Beep frequency selection BC1 BC0 Beep mode with f =8MHz OSC2 0 0 Off 0 1 ~2kHz Output 1 0 ~1kHz Beep signal ~50% duty cycle 1 1 ~500Hz T a ble 43. Main clock controller register map and reset values Address Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 (Hex.) SICSR AVDIE AVDF LVDRF WDGRF 002Bh Reset value 0 0 0 x 0 0 0 x MCCSR MCO CP1 CP0 SMS TB1 TB0 OIE OIF 002Ch Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 MCCBCR BC1 BC0 002Dh Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 73/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx 10.3 16-bit timer 10.3.1 Introduction The timer consists of a 16-bit free-running counter driven by a programmable prescaler. It may be used for a variety of purposes, including pulse length measurement of up to two input signals (input capture) or generation of up to two output waveforms (output compare and PWM). Pulse lengths and waveform periods can be modulated from a few microseconds to several milliseconds using the timer prescaler and the CPU clock prescaler. Some ST7 devices have two on-chip 16-bit timers. They are completely independent, and do not share any resources. They are synchronized after a MCU reset as long as the timer clock frequencies are not modified. This description covers one or two 16-bit timers. In ST7 devices with two timers, register names are prefixed with TA (Timer A) or TB (Timer B). 10.3.2 Main features ● Programmable prescaler: f divided by 2, 4 or 8 CPU ● Overflow status flag and maskable interrupt ● External clock input (must be at least four times slower than the CPU clock speed) with the choice of active edge ● 1 or 2 output compare functions each with: – 2 dedicated 16-bit registers – 2 dedicated programmable signals – 2 dedicated status flags – 1 dedicated maskable interrupt ● 1 or 2 input capture functions each with: – 2 dedicated 16-bit registers – 2 dedicated active edge selection signals – 2 dedicated status flags – 1 dedicated maskable interrupt ● Pulse width modulation mode (PWM) ● One pulse mode ● Reduced power mode ● 5 alternate functions on I/O ports (ICAP1, ICAP2, OCMP1, OCMP2, EXTCLK)(c) The timer block diagram is shown in Figure36. c. Some timer pins may not be available (not bonded) in some ST7 devices. Refer to Section2: Pin description. When reading an input signal on a non-bonded pin, the value will always be ‘1’. 74/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 10.3.3 Functional description Counter The main block of the programmable timer is a 16-bit free running upcounter and its associated 16-bit registers. The 16-bit registers are made up of two 8-bit registers called high and low. ● Counter Register (CR) – Counter High Register (CHR) is the most significant byte (MSB) – Counter Low Register (CLR) is the least significant byte (LSB) ● Alternate Counter Register (ACR) – Alternate Counter High Register (ACHR) is the most significant byte (MSB) – Alternate Counter Low Register (ACLR) is the least significant byte (LSB) These two read-only 16-bit registers contain the same value but with the difference that reading the ACLR register does not clear the TOF bit (timer overflow flag), located in the Status register (SR) (see note at the end of paragraph entitled 16-bit read sequence). Writing in the CLR register or ACLR register resets the free running counter to the FFFCh value. Both counters have a reset value of FFFCh (this is the only value which is reloaded in the 16-bit timer). The reset value of both counters is also FFFCh in one pulse mode and PWM mode. The timer clock depends on the clock control bits of the CR2 register, as illustrated in Table50. The value in the counter register repeats every 131072, 262144 or 524288 CPU clock cycles depending on the CC[1:0] bits. The timer frequency can be f /2, f /4, CPU CPU f /8 or an external frequency. CPU 75/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Figure 36. Timer block diagram ST7 internal bus fCPU MCU-peripheral interface 8 high 8 low 8-bit 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 buffer EXEDG high low high low high low high low 16 1/2 Output Output Input Input Counter 1/4 register Compare Compare Capture Capture 1/8 register register register register 1 2 1 2 EXTCLK Alternate pin Counter register 16 16 16 CC[1:0] Timer internal bus 16 16 ODveertefloctw Output Compare Edge Detect ICAP1 circuit circuit 1 circuit pin 6 Edge Detect ICAP2 circuit 2 pin Latch 1 OCMP1 pin ICF1OCF1TOF ICF2OCF2TIMD 0 0 (Control/Status register) CSR Latch 2 OCMP2 pin ICIE OCIE TOIEFOLV2FOLV1OLVL2IEDG1OLVL1 OC1EOC2EOPM PWM CC1 CC0 IEDG2EXEDG (Control register 1) CR1 (Control register 2) CR2 (See note 1) Timer interrupt 1. If IC, OC and TO interrupt requests have separate vectors then the last OR is not present (see Table25: Interrupt mapping on page51). 76/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 16-bit read sequence The 16-bit read sequence (from either the Counter register or the Alternate Counter register) is illustrated in the following Figure37. Figure 37. 16-bit read sequence Beginning of the sequence At t0 Read MSB LSB is buffered Other instructions At t0 +Δt Read LSB RLSeBtu rvnaslu teh ea tb tu0ffered Sequence completed The user must first read the MSB, afterwhich the LSB value is automatically buffered. This buffered value remains unchanged until the 16-bit read sequence is completed, even if the user reads the MSB several times. After a complete reading sequence, if only the CLR register or ACLR register are read, they return the LSB of the count value at the time of the read. Whatever the timer mode used (input capture, output compare, one pulse mode or PWM mode) an overflow occurs when the counter rolls over from FFFFh to 0000h then: ● The TOF bit of the SR register is set. ● A timer interrupt is generated if: – TOIE bit of the CR1 register is set and – I bit of the CC register is cleared. If one of these conditions is false, the interrupt remains pending to be issued as soon as they are both true. Clearing the overflow interrupt request is done in two steps: 1. Reading the SR register while the TOF bit is set. 2. An access (read or write) to the CLR register. Note: The TOF bit is not cleared by access to the ACLR register. The advantage of accessing the ACLR register rather than the CLR register is that it allows simultaneous use of the overflow function and reading the free running counter at random times (for example, to measure elapsed time) without the risk of clearing the TOF bit erroneously. The timer is not affected by Wait mode. In Halt mode, the counter stops counting until the mode is exited. Counting then resumes from the previous count (MCU awakened by an interrupt) or from the reset count (MCU awakened by a reset). 77/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx External clock The external clock (where available) is selected if CC0=1 and CC1=1 in the CR2 register. The status of the EXEDG bit in the CR2 register determines the type of level transition on the external clock pin EXTCLK that will trigger the free running counter. The counter is synchronized with the falling edge of the internal CPU clock. A minimum of four falling edges of the CPU clock must occur between two consecutive active edges of the external clock; thus the external clock frequency must be less than a quarter of the CPU clock frequency. Figure 38. Counter timing diagram, internal clock divided by 2 CPU clock Internal reset Timer clock FFFD FFFE FFFF 0000 0001 0002 0003 Counter register Timer Overflow Flag (TOF) Figure 39. Counter timing diagram, internal clock divided by 4 CPU clock Internal reset Timer clock Counter register FFFC FFFD 0000 0001 Timer Overflow Flag (TOF) Figure 40. Counter timing diagram, internal clock divided by 8 CPU clock Internal reset Timer clock Counter register FFFC FFFD 0000 Timer Overflow Flag (TOF) Note: The MCU is in reset state when the internal reset signal is high, when it is low the MCU is running. 78/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Input capture In this section, the index, i, may be 1 or 2 because there are two input capture functions in the 16-bit timer. The two 16-bit input capture registers (IC1R/IC2R) are used to latch the value of the free running counter after a transition is detected on the ICAPi pin (see Figure42). T able 44. Input capture byte distribution Register MS byte LS byte ICiR ICiHR ICiLR The ICiR registers are read-only registers. The active transition is software programmable through the IEDGi bit of Control Registers (CRi). Timing resolution is one count of the free running counter: (f /CC[1:0]). CPU Procedure To use the input capture function select the following in the CR2 register: ● Select the timer clock (CC[1:0]) (see Table50). ● Select the edge of the active transition on the ICAP2 pin with the IEDG2 bit (the ICAP2 pin must be configured as floating input or input with pull-up without interrupt if this configuration is available). Select the following in the CR1 register: ● Set the ICIE bit to generate an interrupt after an input capture coming from either the ICAP1 pin or the ICAP2 pin ● Select the edge of the active transition on the ICAP1 pin with the IEDG1 bit (the ICAP1pin must be configured as floating input or input with pull-up without interrupt if this configuration is available). When an input capture occurs: ● ICFi bit is set. ● The ICiR register contains the value of the free running counter on the active transition on the ICAPi pin (see Figure42). ● A timer interrupt is generated if the ICIE bit is set and the I bit is cleared in the CC register. Otherwise, the interrupt remains pending until both conditions become true. Clearing the Input Capture interrupt request (that is, clearing the ICFi bit) is done in two steps: 1. Reading the SR register while the ICFi bit is set 2. An access (read or write) to the ICiLR register 79/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Note: 1 After reading the ICiHR register, transfer of input capture data is inhibited and ICFi will never be set until the ICiLR register is also read. 2 The ICiR register contains the free running counter value which corresponds to the most recent input capture. 3 The two input capture functions can be used together even if the timer also uses the two output compare functions. 4 In One pulse mode and PWM mode only Input Capture 2 can be used. 5 The alternate inputs (ICAP1 and ICAP2) are always directly connected to the timer. So any transitions on these pins activates the input capture function. Moreover if one of the ICAPi pins is configured as an input and the second one as an output, an interrupt can be generated if the user toggles the output pin and if the ICIE bit is set. This can be avoided if the input capture function i is disabled by reading the ICiHR (see note1). 6 The TOF bit can be used with interrupt generation in order to measure events that go beyond the timer range (FFFFh). Figure 41. Input capture block diagram ICAP1 (Control register 1) CR1 pin Edge Detect Edge Detect ICIE IEDG1 circuit 2 circuit 1 ICAP2 pin (Status register) SR IC2R register IC1R register ICF1 ICF2 0 0 0 16-bit (Control register 2) CR2 CC1 CC0 IEDG2 16-bit free running counter Figure 42. Input capture timing diagram Timer clock Counter register FF01 FF02 FF03 ICAPi pin ICAPi flag FF03 ICAPi register Note: The rising edge is the active edge. 80/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Output compare In this section, the index, i, may be 1 or 2 because there are two output compare functions in the 16-bit timer. This function can be used to control an output waveform or indicate when a period of time has elapsed. When a match is found between the Output Compare register and the free running counter, the output compare function: – Assigns pins with a programmable value if the OCiE bit is set – Sets a flag in the status register – Generates an interrupt if enabled Two 16-bit registers Output Compare register 1 (OC1R) and Output Compare register 2 (OC2R) contain the value to be compared to the counter register each timer clock cycle. T able 45. Output compare byte distribution Register MS byte LS byte OCiR OCiHR OCiLR These registers are readable and witable and are not affected by the timer hardware. A reset event changes the OCiR value to 8000h. Timing resolution is one count of the free running counter: (f /CC[1:0]). CPU Procedure To use the Output Compare function, select the following in the CR2 register: ● Set the OCiE bit if an output is needed then the OCMPi pin is dedicated to the output compare i signal. ● Select the timer clock (CC[1:0]) (see Table50). And select the following in the CR1 register: ● Select the OLVLi bit to applied to the OCMPi pins after the match occurs. ● Set the OCIE bit to generate an interrupt if it is needed. When a match is found between OCRi register and CR register: ● OCFi bit is set ● The OCMPi pin takes OLVLi bit value (OCMPi pin latch is forced low during reset) ● A timer interrupt is generated if the OCIE bit is set in the CR1 register and the I bit is cleared in the CC register (CC). The OCiR register value required for a specific timing application can be calculated using the following formula: Δt f Δ OCiR = * CPU PRESC Where: Δt = Output compare period (in seconds) f = CPU clock frequency (in hertz) CPU PRESC = Timer prescaler factor (2, 4 or 8 depending on CC[1:0] bits; see Table50) 81/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx If the timer clock is an external clock, the formula is: Δ OCiR = Δt f * EXT Where: Δt = Output compare period (in seconds) f = External timer clock frequency (in hertz) EXT Clearing the output compare interrupt request (that is, clearing the OCFi bit) is done by: 1. Reading the SR register while the OCFi bit is set. 2. An access (read or write) to the OCiLR register. The following procedure is recommended to prevent the OCFi bit from being set between the time it is read and the write to the OCiR register: ● Write to the OCiHR register (further compares are inhibited). ● Read the SR register (first step of the clearance of the OCFi bit, which may be already set). ● Write to the OCiLR register (enables the output compare function and clears the OCFi bit). Note: 1 After a processor write cycle to the OCiHR register, the output compare function is inhibited until the OCiLR register is also written. 2 If the OCiE bit is not set, the OCMPi pin is a general I/O port and the OLVLi bit will not appear when a match is found but an interrupt could be generated if the OCIE bit is set. 3 In both internal and external clock modes, OCFi and OCMPi are set while the counter value equals the OCiR register value (see Figure44 on page83 for an example with f /2 and CPU Figure45 on page83 for an example with f /4). This behavior is the same in OPM or CPU PWM mode. 4 The output compare functions can be used both for generating external events on the OCMPi pins even if the input capture mode is also used. 5 The value in the 16-bit OCiR register and the OLVi bit should be changed after each successful comparison in order to control an output waveform or establish a new elapsed timeout. Forced output compare capability When the FOLVi bit is set by software, the OLVLi bit is copied to the OCMPi pin. The OLVi bit has to be toggled in order to toggle the OCMPi pin when it is enabled (OCiE bit=1). The OCFi bit is then not set by hardware, and thus no interrupt request is generated. The FOLVLi bits have no effect in both one pulse mode and PWM mode. 82/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Figure 43. Output compare block diagram 16-bit free running counter OC1EOC2E CC1 CC0 (Control Register 2) CR2 16-bit (Control Register 1) CR1 Output compare circuit OCIE FOLV2FOLV1OLVL2 OLVL1 Latch 1 OCMP1 Pin 16-bit 16-bit Latch OCMP2 2 OC1R register Pin OCF1 OCF2 0 0 0 OC2R register (Status register) SR Figure 44. Output compare timing diagram, f =f /2 TIMER CPU Internal CPU clock Timer clock Counter register 2ECF 2ED0 2ED1 2ED2 2ED3 2ED4 Output Compare register i (OCRi) 2ED3 Output Compare flag i (OCFi) OCMPi pin (OLVLi=1) Figure 45. Output compare timing diagram, f =f /4 TIMER CPU Internal CPU clock Timer clock Counter register 2ECF 2ED0 2ED1 2ED2 2ED3 2ED4 Output Compare register i (OCRi) 2ED3 Output Compare flag i (OCFi) OCMPi pin (OLVLi=1) 83/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx One Pulse mode One Pulse mode enables the generation of a pulse when an external event occurs. This mode is selected via the OPM bit in the CR2 register. The one pulse mode uses the Input Capture1 function and the Output Compare1 function. Procedure To use One Pulse mode: 1. Load the OC1R register with the value corresponding to the length of the pulse (see the formula below). 2. Select the following in the CR1 register: – Using the OLVL1 bit, select the level to be applied to the OCMP1 pin after the pulse. – Using the OLVL2 bit, select the level to be applied to the OCMP1 pin during the pulse. – Select the edge of the active transition on the ICAP1 pin with the IEDG1 bit (the ICAP1 pin must be configured as floating input). 3. Select the following in the CR2 register: – Set the OC1E bit, the OCMP1 pin is then dedicated to the Output Compare 1 function. – Set the OPM bit. – Select the timer clock CC[1:0] (see Table50). Figure 46. One pulse mode cycle When ICR1 = Counter event occurs OCMP1 = OLVL2 on ICAP1 Counter is reset to FFFCh ICF1 bit is set When counter = OC1R OCMP1 = OLVL1 Then, on a valid event on the ICAP1 pin, the counter is initialized to FFFCh and OLVL2 bit is loaded on the OCMP1 pin, the ICF1 bit is set and the value FFFDh is loaded in the IC1R register. Because the ICF1 bit is set when an active edge occurs, an interrupt can be generated if the ICIE bit is set. Clearing the Input Capture interrupt request (that is, clearing the ICFi bit) is done in two steps: 1. Reading the SR register while the ICFi bit is set. 2. An access (read or write) to the ICiLR register. 84/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals The OC1R register value required for a specific timing application can be calculated using the following formula: OCiR value = t * fCPU - 5 PRESC Where: t = Pulse period (in seconds) f = CPU clock frequnency (in hertz) CPU PRESC = Timer prescaler factor (2, 4 or 8 depending on the CC[1:0] bits; see Table50) If the timer clock is an external clock the formula is: OCiR = t f - 5 * EXT Where: t = Pulse period (in seconds) f = External timer clock frequency (in hertz) EXT When the value of the counter is equal to the value of the contents of the OC1R register, the OLVL1 bit is output on the OCMP1 pin (see Figure47). Note: 1 The OCF1 bit cannot be set by hardware in one pulse mode but the OCF2 bit can generate an Output Compare interrupt. 2 When the Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) and One Pulse Mode (OPM) bits are both set, the PWM mode is the only active one. 3 If OLVL1=OLVL2 a continuous signal will be seen on the OCMP1 pin. 4 The ICAP1 pin can not be used to perform input capture. The ICAP2 pin can be used to perform input capture (ICF2 can be set and IC2R can be loaded) but the user must take care that the counter is reset each time a valid edge occurs on the ICAP1 pin and ICF1 can also generates interrupt if ICIE is set. 5 When one pulse mode is used OC1R is dedicated to this mode. Nevertheless OC2R and OCF2 can be used to indicate a period of time has been elapsed but cannot generate an output waveform because the level OLVL2 is dedicated to the one pulse mode. Figure 47. One Pulse mode timing example(1) IC1R 01F8 2ED3 Counter 01F8 FFFC FFFD FFFE 2ED0 2ED1 2ED2 FFFC FFFD 2ED3 ICAP1 OCMP1 OLVL2 OLVL1 OLVL2 Compare1 1. IEDG1=1, OC1R=2ED0h, OLVL1=0, OLVL2=1 85/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Figure 48. Pulse width modulation mode timing example with two output compare functions(1)(2) Counter 34E2 FFFC FFFD FFFE 2ED0 2ED1 2ED2 34E2 FFFC OCMP1 OLVL2 OLVL1 OLVL2 compare2 compare1 compare2 1. OC1R=2ED0h, OC2R=34E2, OLVL1=0, OLVL2= 1 2. On timers with only one Output Compare register, a fixed frequency PWM signal can be generated using the output compare and the counter overflow to define the pulse length. Pulse Width Modulation mode Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) mode enables the generation of a signal with a frequency and pulse length determined by the value of the OC1R and OC2R registers. Pulse Width Modulation mode uses the complete Output Compare 1 function plus the OC2R register, and so this functionality can not be used when PWM mode is activated. In PWM mode, double buffering is implemented on the output compare registers. Any new values written in the OC1R and OC2R registers are taken into account only at the end of the PWM period (OC2) to avoid spikes on the PWM output pin (OCMP1). Procedure To use Pulse Width Modulation mode: 1. Load the OC2R register with the value corresponding to the period of the signal using the formula below. 2. Load the OC1R register with the value corresponding to the period of the pulse if (OLVL1=0 and OLVL2=1) using the formula in the opposite column. 3. Select the following in the CR1 register: – Using the OLVL1 bit, select the level to be applied to the OCMP1 pin after a successful comparison with the OC1R register. – Using the OLVL2 bit, select the level to be applied to the OCMP1 pin after a successful comparison with the OC2R register. 4. Select the following in the CR2 register: – Set OC1E bit: the OCMP1 pin is then dedicated to the output compare 1 function. – Set the PWM bit. – Select the timer clock (CC[1:0]) (see Table50). 86/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Figure 49. Pulse width modulation cycle When counter OCMP1 = OLVL1 = OC1R When OCMP1 = OLVL2 counter counter is reset = OC2R to FFFCh ICF1 bit is set If OLVL1=1 and OLVL2=0, the length of the positive pulse is the difference between the OC2R and OC1R registers. If OLVL1=OLVL2, a continuous signal will be seen on the OCMP1 pin. The OC1R register value required for a specific timing application can be calculated using the following formula: OCiR value = t * fCPU - 5 PRESC Where: t = Signal or pulse period (in seconds) f = CPU clock frequnency (in Hertz) CPU PRESC = Timer prescaler factor (2, 4 or 8 depending on the CC[1:0] bits; see Table50) If the timer clock is an external clock the formula is: OCiR = t f - 5 * EXT Where: t = Signal or pulse period (in seconds) f = External timer clock frequency (in Hertz) EXT The Output Compare 2 event causes the counter to be initialized to FFFCh (see Figure48). Note: 1 After a write instruction to the OCiHR register, the output compare function is inhibited until the OCiLR register is also written. 2 The OCF1 and OCF2 bits cannot be set by hardware in PWM mode therefore the Output Compare interrupt is inhibited. 3 The ICF1 bit is set by hardware when the counter reaches the OC2R value and can produce a timer interrupt if the ICIE bit is set and the I bit is cleared. 4 In PWM mode the ICAP1 pin can not be used to perform input capture because it is disconnected to the timer. The ICAP2 pin can be used to perform input capture (ICF2 can be set and IC2R can be loaded) but the user must take care that the counter is reset each period and ICF1 can also generates interrupt if ICIE is set. 5 When the Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) and One Pulse Mode (OPM) bits are both set, the PWM mode is the only active one. 87/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx 10.3.4 Low power modes T able 46. Effect of low power modes on 16-bit timer Mode Description No effect on 16-bit timer. Wait Timer interrupts cause the device to exit from Wait mode. 16-bit timer registers are frozen. In Halt mode, the counter stops counting until Halt mode is exited. Counting resumes from the previous count when the MCU is woken up by an interrupt with Exit from Halt mode capability or from the counter reset value when the MCU is woken up by a reset. Halt If an input capture event occurs on the ICAPi pin, the input capture detection circuitry is armed. Consequently, when the MCU is woken up by an interrupt with Exit from Halt mode capability, the ICFi bit is set, and the counter value present when exiting from Halt mode is captured into the ICiR register. 10.3.5 Interrupts T able 47. 16-bit timer interrupt control/wakeup capability(1) Interrupt event Event flag Enable Control bit Exit from Wait Exit from Halt Input Capture 1 event/counter ICF1 reset in PWM mode ICIE Input Capture 2 event ICF2 Output Compare 1 event OCF1 Yes No (not available in PWM mode) OCIE Output Compare 2 event OCF2 (not available in PWM mode) Timer Overflow event TOF TOIE 1. The 16-bit timer interrupt events are connected to the same interrupt vector (see Section7: Interrupts). These events generate an interrupt if the corresponding Enable Control bit is set and the interrupt mask in the CC register is reset (RIM instruction). 88/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 10.3.6 Summary of timer modes T able 48. Summary of timer modes Timer resources Mode Input Input Output Output Capture 1 Capture 2 Compare 1 Compare 2 Input Capture (1 and/or 2) Yes Yes Yes Yes Output Compare (1 and/or 2) One Pulse mode Not recommended(1) Partially(2) No No PWM mode Not recommended(3) No 1. See note 4 in One Pulse mode on page84. 2. See note 5 in One Pulse mode on page84. 3. See note 4 in Pulse Width Modulation mode on page86. 10.3.7 16-bit timer registers Each timer is associated with three control and status registers, and with six pairs of data registers (16-bit values) relating to the two input captures, the two output compares, the counter and the alternate counter. Control Register 1 (CR1) CR1 Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ICIE OCIE TOIE FOLV2 FOLV1 OLVL2 IEDG1 OLVL1 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W T aM ble 49. CR1 register description Bit Name Function Input Capture Interrupt Enable 0: Interrupt is inhibited. 7 ICIE 1: A timer interrupt is generated whenever the ICF1 or ICF2 bit of the SR register is set. Output Compare Interrupt Enable 0: Interrupt is inhibited. 6 OCIE 1: A timer interrupt is generated whenever the OCF1 or OCF2 bit of the SR register is set. Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable 5 TOIE 0: Interrupt is inhibited. 1: A timer interrupt is enabled whenever the TOF bit of the SR register is set. 89/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Table 49. CR1 register description (continued) Bit Name Function Forced Output compare 2 This bit is set and cleared by software. 4 FOLV2 0: No effect on the OCMP2 pin. 1: Forces the OLVL2 bit to be copied to the OCMP2 pin, if the OC2E bit is set and even if there is no successful comparison. Forced Output compare 1 This bit is set and cleared by software. 3 FOLV1 0: No effect on the OCMP1 pin. 1: Forces OLVL1 to be copied to the OCMP1 pin, if the OC1E bit is set and even if there is no successful comparison. Output Level 2 This bit is copied to the OCMP2 pin whenever a successful comparison occurs with 2 OLVL2 the OC2R register and OCxE is set in the CR2 register. This value is copied to the OCMP1 pin in One Pulse mode and Pulse Width modulation mode. Input Edge 1 This bit determines which type of level transition on the ICAP1 pin will trigger the 1 IEDG1 capture. 0: A falling edge triggers the capture. 1: A rising edge triggers the capture. Output Level 1 0 OLVL1 The OLVL1 bit is copied to the OCMP1 pin whenever a successful comparison occurs with the OC1R register and the OC1E bit is set in the CR2 register. Control Register 2 (CR2) CR2 Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 OC1E OC2E OPM PWM CC[1:0] IEDG2 EXEDG R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W T aM ble 50. CR2 register description Bit Name Function Output compare 1 pin enable This bit is used only to output the signal from the timer on the OCMP1 pin (OLV1 in Output Compare mode, both OLV1 and OLV2 in PWM and One-Pulse mode). 7 OCIE Whatever the value of the OC1E bit, the Output Compare 1 function of the timer remains active. 0: OCMP1 pin alternate function disabled (I/O pin free for general-purpose I/O). 1: OCMP1 pin alternate function enabled. Output compare 2 pin enable This bit is used only to output the signal from the timer on the OCMP2 pin (OLV2 in Output Compare mode). Whatever the value of the OC2E bit, the Output Compare 2 6 OC2E function of the timer remains active. 0: OCMP2 pin alternate function disabled (I/O pin free for general-purpose I/O). 1: OCMP2 pin alternate function enabled. 90/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Table 50. CR2 register description (continued) Bit Name Function One Pulse mode 0: One Pulse mode is not active. 5 OPM 1: One Pulse mode is active, the ICAP1 pin can be used to trigger one pulse on the OCMP1 pin; the active transition is given by the IEDG1 bit. The length of the generated pulse depends on the contents of the OC1R register. Pulse width modulation 0: PWM mode is not active. 4 PWM 1: PWM mode is active, the OCMP1 pin outputs a programmable cyclic signal; the length of the pulse depends on the value of OC1R register; the period depends on the value of OC2R register. Clock control The timer clock mode depends on these bits. 00: Timer clock=f /4 CPU 01: Timer clock=f /2 3:2 CC[1:0] CPU 10: Timer clock=f /8 CPU 11: Timer clock=external clock (where available) Note: If the external clock pin is not available, programming the external clock configuration stops the counter. Input edge 2 This bit determines which type of level transition on the ICAP2 pin will trigger the 1 IEDG2 capture. 0: A falling edge triggers the capture. 1: A rising edge triggers the capture. External clock edge This bit determines which type of level transition on the external clock pin EXTCLK 0 EXEDG will trigger the counter register. 0: A falling edge triggers the counter register. 1: A rising edge triggers the counter register. Control/Status Register (CSR) CSR Reset value: xxxx x0xx (xxh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ICF1 OCF1 TOF ICF2 OCF2 TIMD Reserved RO RO RO RO RO R/W - T aM ble 51. CSR register description Bit Name Function Input capture flag 1 0: No input capture (reset value). 7 ICF1 1: An input capture has occurred on the ICAP1 pin or the counter has reached the OC2R value in PWM mode. To clear this bit, first read the SR register, then read or write the low byte of the IC1R (IC1LR) register. 91/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Table 51. CSR register description (continued) Bit Name Function Output compare flag 1 0: No match (reset value). 6 OCF1 1: The content of the free running counter has matched the content of the OC1R register. To clear this bit, first read the SR register, then read or write the low byte of the OC1R (OC1LR) register. Timer overflow flag 0: No timer overflow (reset value). 5 TOF 1: The free running counter rolled over from FFFFh to 0000h. To clear this bit, first read the SR register, then read or write the low byte of the CR (CLR) register. Note: Reading or writing the ACLR register does not clear TOF. Input capture flag 2 0: No input capture (reset value). 4 ICF2 1: An Input Capture has occurred on the ICAP2 pin. To clear this bit, first read the SR register, then read or write the low byte of the IC2R (IC2LR) register. Output compare flag 2 0: No match (reset value). 3 OCF2 1: The content of the free running counter has matched the content of the OC2R register. To clear this bit, first read the SR register, then read or write the low byte of the OC2R (OC2LR) register. Timer disable This bit is set and cleared by software. When set, it freezes the timer prescaler and counter and disabled the output functions (OCMP1 and OCMP2 pins) to reduce 2 TIMD power consumption. Access to the timer registers is still available, allowing the timer configuration to be changed, or the counter reset, while it is disabled. 0: Timer enabled. 1: Timer prescaler, counter and outputs disabled. 1:0 - Reserved, must be kept cleared. Input capture 1 high register (IC1HR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the high part of the counter value (transferred by the input capture 1 event). IC1HR Reset value: undefined 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO 92/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Input capture 1 low register (IC1LR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the low part of the counter value (transferred by the input capture 1 event). IC1LR Reset value: undefined 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Output compare 1 high register (OC1HR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the high part of the value to be compared to the CHR register. OC1HR Reset value: 1000 0000 (80h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Output compare 1 low register (OC1LR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the low part of the value to be compared to the CLR register. OC1LR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Output compare 2 high register (OC2HR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the high part of the value to be compared to the CHR register. OC2HR Reset value: 1000 0000 (80h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 93/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Output compare 2 low register (OC2LR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the low part of the value to be compared to the CLR register. OC2LR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Counter high register (CHR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the high part of the counter value. CHR Reset value: 1111 1111 (FFh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Counter low register (CLR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the low part of the counter value. A write to this register resets the counter. An access to this register after accessing the CSR register clears the TOF bit. CLR Reset value: 1111 1100 (FCh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Alternate counter high register (ACHR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the high part of the counter value. ACHR Reset value: 1111 1111 (FFh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO 94/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Alternate counter low register (ACLR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the low part of the counter value. A write to this register resets the counter. An access to this register after an access to CSR register does not clear the TOF bit in the CSR register. ACLR Reset value: 1111 1100 (FCh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Input capture 2 high register (IC2HR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the high part of the counter value (transferred by the Input Capture 2 event). 1C2HR Reset value: undefined 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Input capture 2 low register (IC2LR) This is an 8-bit register that contains the low part of the counter value (transferred by the Input Capture 2 event). 1C2LR Reset value: undefined 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 MSB LSB RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO Table 52. 1 6-bit timer register map and reset values Address Register 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 (Hex.) label Timer A: 32 CR1 ICIE OCIE TOIE FOLV2 FOLV1 OLVL2 IEDG1 OLVL1 Timer B: 42 Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Timer A: 31 CR2 OC1E OC2E OPM PWM CC1 CC0 IEDG2 EXEDG Timer B: 41 Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Timer A: 33 CSR ICF1 OCF1 TOF ICF2 OCF2 TIMD - - Timer B: 43 Reset value x x x x x 0 x x Timer A: 34 IC1HR MSB LSB Timer B: 44 Reset value x x x x x x x x Timer A: 35 IC1LR MSB LSB Timer B: 45 Reset value x x x x x x x x 95/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Table 52. 16-bit timer register map and reset values (continued) Address Register 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 (Hex.) label Timer A: 36 OC1HR MSB LSB Timer B: 46 Reset value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Timer A: 37 OC1LR MSB LSB Timer B: 47 Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Timer A: 3E OC2HR MSB LSB Timer B: 4E Reset value 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Timer A: 3F OC2LR MSB LSB Timer B: 4F Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Timer A: 38 CHR MSB LSB Timer B: 48 Reset value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Timer A: 39 CLR MSB LSB Timer B: 49 Reset value 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 Timer A: 3A ACHR MSB LSB Timer B: 4A Reset value 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Timer A: 3B ACLR MSB LSB Timer B: 4B Reset value 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 Timer A: 3C IC2HR MSB LSB Timer B: 4C Reset value x x x x x x x x Timer A: 3D IC2LR MSB LSB Timer B: 4D Reset value x x x x x x x x 10.4 Serial peripheral interface (SPI) 10.4.1 Introduction The serial peripheral interface (SPI) allows full-duplex, synchronous, serial communication with external devices. An SPI system may consist of a master and one or more slaves. However, the SPI interface can not be a master in a multi-master system. 10.4.2 Main features ● Full duplex synchronous transfers (on 3 lines) ● Simplex synchronous transfers (on 2 lines) ● Master or slave operation ● 6 master mode frequencies (f /4 max.) CPU ● f /2 max. slave mode frequency (see note) CPU ● SS Management by software or hardware ● Programmable clock polarity and phase ● End of transfer interrupt flag ● Write collision, Master mode fault and Overrun flags Note: In slave mode, continuous transmission is not possible at maximum frequency due to the software overhead for clearing status flags and to initiate the next transmission sequence. 96/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 10.4.3 General description Figure50 shows the serial peripheral interface (SPI) block diagram. The SPI has three registers: – SPI Control Register (SPICR) – SPI Control/Status Register (SPICSR) – SPI Data Register (SPIDR) The SPI is connected to external devices through four pins: – MISO: Master In / Slave Out data – MOSI: Master Out / Slave In data – SCK: Serial Clock out by SPI masters and input by SPI slaves – SS: Slave select: This input signal acts as a ‘chip select’ to let the SPI master communicate with slaves individually and to avoid contention on the data lines. Slave SS inputs can be driven by standard I/O ports on the master MCU. Figure 50. Serial peripheral interface block diagram Data/Address bus Read SPIDR Interrupt request Read Buffer MOSI 7 SPICSR 0 MISO 8-bit Shift Register SPIFWCOL OVR MODF 0 SOD SSM SSI Write SOD bit 1 SS SPI 0 SCK state control 7 SPICR 0 SPIE SPE SPR2MSTRCPOLCPHASPR1SPR0 Master control Serial clock generator SS Functional description A basic example of interconnections between a single master and a single slave is illustrated in Figure51. The MOSI pins are connected together and the MISO pins are connected together. In this way data is transferred serially between master and slave (most significant bit first). 97/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx The communication is always initiated by the master. When the master device transmits data to a slave device via MOSI pin, the slave device responds by sending data to the master device via the MISO pin. This implies full duplex communication with both data out and data in synchronized with the same clock signal (which is provided by the master device via the SCK pin). To use a single data line, the MISO and MOSI pins must be connected at each node (in this case only simplex communication is possible). Four possible data/clock timing relationships may be chosen (see Figure54) but master and slave must be programmed with the same timing mode. Figure 51. Single master/single slave application Master Slave MSB LSB MSB LSB MISO MISO 8-bit Shift Register 8-bit Shift Register MOSI MOSI SPI clock SCK SCK generator SS +5V SS Not used if SS is managed by software Slave select management As an alternative to using the SS pin to control the Slave Select signal, the application can choose to manage the Slave Select signal by software. This is configured by the SSM bit in the SPICSR register (see Figure53). In software management, the external SS pin is free for other application uses and the internal SS signal level is driven by writing to the SSI bit in the SPICSR register. In Master mode: – SS internal must be held high continuously Depending on the data/clock timing relationship, there are two cases in Slave mode (see Figure52): If CPHA=1 (data latched on second clock edge): – SS internal must be held low during the entire transmission. This implies that in single slave applications the SS pin either can be tied to V , or made free for SS standard I/O by managing the SS function by software (SSM=1 and SSI=0 in the in the SPICSR register) If CPHA=0 (data latched on first clock edge): – SS internal must be held low during byte transmission and pulled high between each byte to allow the slave to write to the shift register. If SS is not pulled high, a Write Collision error will occur when the slave writes to the shift register (see Write collision error (WCOL) on page102). 98/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Figure 52. Generic SS timing diagram MOSI/MISO Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Master SS Slave SS (if CPHA=0) Slave SS (if CPHA=1) Figure 53. Hardware/software slave select management SSM bit SSI bit 1 SS internal SS external pin 0 Master mode operation In master mode, the serial clock is output on the SCK pin. The clock frequency, polarity and phase are configured by software (refer to the description of the SPICSR register). Note: The idle state of SCK must correspond to the polarity selected in the SPICSR register (by pulling up SCK if CPOL=1 or pulling down SCK if CPOL=0). How to operate the SPI in master mode To operate the SPI in master mode, perform the following steps in order: 1. Write to the SPICR register: – Select the clock frequency by configuring the SPR[2:0] bits. – Select the clock polarity and clock phase by configuring the CPOL and CPHA bits. Figure54 shows the four possible configurations. Note: The slave must have the same CPOL and CPHA settings as the master. 2. Write to the SPICSR register: – Either set the SSM bit and set the SSI bit or clear the SSM bit and tie the SS pin high for the complete byte transmit sequence. 3. Write to the SPICR register: – Set the MSTR and SPE bits. Note: MSTR and SPE bits remain set only if SS is high. Caution: If the SPICSR register is not written first, the SPICR register setting (MSTR bit) might not be taken into account. The transmit sequence begins when software writes a byte in the SPIDR register. 99/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Master mode transmit sequence When software writes to the SPIDR register, the data byte is loaded into the 8-bit shift register and then shifted out serially to the MOSI pin most significant bit first. When data transfer is complete: – The SPIF bit is set by hardware – An interrupt request is generated if the SPIE bit is set and the interrupt mask in the CCR register is cleared. Clearing the SPIF bit is performed by the following software sequence: 1. An access to the SPICSR register while the SPIF bit is set. 2. A read to the SPIDR register. Note: While the SPIF bit is set, all writes to the SPIDR register are inhibited until the SPICSR register is read. Slave mode operation In slave mode, the serial clock is received on the SCK pin from the master device. To operate the SPI in slave mode: 1. Write to the SPICSR register to perform the following actions: – Select the clock polarity and clock phase by configuring the CPOL and CPHA bits (see Figure54). The slave must have the same CPOL and CPHA settings as the master. – Manage the SS pin as described in Slave select management on page98 and Figure52. If CPHA=1, SS must be held low continuously. If CPHA=0, SS must be held low during byte transmission and pulled up between each byte to let the slave write in the shift register. 2. Write to the SPICR register to clear the MSTR bit and set the SPE bit to enable the SPI I/O functions. Slave mode transmit sequence When software writes to the SPIDR register, the data byte is loaded into the 8-bit shift register and then shifted out serially to the MISO pin most significant bit first. The transmit sequence begins when the slave device receives the clock signal and the most significant bit of the data on its MOSI pin. When data transfer is complete: – The SPIF bit is set by hardware – An interrupt request is generated if SPIE bit is set and interrupt mask in the CCR register is cleared. Clearing the SPIF bit is performed by the following software sequence: 1. An access to the SPICSR register while the SPIF bit is set. 2. A write or a read to the SPIDR register. Note: While the SPIF bit is set, all writes to the SPIDR register are inhibited until the SPICSR register is read. 100/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals The SPIF bit can be cleared during a second transmission; however, it must be cleared before the second SPIF bit in order to prevent an Overrun condition (see Overrun condition (OVR) on page102). 10.4.4 Clock phase and clock polarity Four possible timing relationships may be chosen by software, using the CPOL and CPHA bits (see Figure54). Note: The idle state of SCK must correspond to the polarity selected in the SPICSR register (by pulling up SCK if CPOL=1 or pulling down SCK if CPOL=0). The combination of the CPOL clock polarity and CPHA (clock phase) bits selects the data capture clock edge Figure54 shows an SPI transfer with the four combinations of the CPHA and CPOL bits. The diagram may be interpreted as a master or slave timing diagram where the SCK, MISO and MOSI pins are directly connected between the master and the slave device. Note: If CPOL is changed at the communication byte boundaries, the SPI must be disabled by resetting the SPE bit. Figure 54. Data clock timing diagram(1) CPHA =1 SCK (CPOL = 1) SCK (CPOL = 0) MISO MSB Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB (from master) MOSI (from slave) MSB Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB SS (to slave) Capture strobe CPHA =0 SCK (CPOL = 1) SCK (CPOL = 0) MISO MSB Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB (from master) MOSI (from slave) MSB Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit3 Bit 2 Bit 1 LSB SS (to slave) Capture strobe 1. This figure should not be used as a replacement for parametric information. Refer to the Electrical Characteristics chapter. 101/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx 10.4.5 Error flags Master mode fault (MODF) Master mode fault occurs when the master device has its SS pin pulled low. When a Master mode fault occurs: – The MODF bit is set and an SPI interrupt request is generated if the SPIE bit is set. – The SPE bit is reset. This blocks all output from the device and disables the SPI peripheral. – The MSTR bit is reset, thus forcing the device into slave mode. Clearing the MODF bit is done through a software sequence: 1. A read access to the SPICSR register while the MODF bit is set. 2. A write to the SPICR register. Note: To avoid any conflicts in an application with multiple slaves, the SS pin must be pulled high during the MODF bit clearing sequence. The SPE and MSTR bits may be restored to their original state during or after this clearing sequence. Hardware does not allow the user to set the SPE and MSTR bits while the MODF bit is set except in the MODF bit clearing sequence. Overrun condition (OVR) An overrun condition occurs, when the master device has sent a data byte and the slave device has not cleared the SPIF bit issued from the previously transmitted byte. When an Overrun occurs the OVR bit is set and an interrupt request is generated if the SPIE bit is set. In this case, the receiver buffer contains the byte sent after the SPIF bit was last cleared. A read to the SPIDR register returns this byte. All other bytes are lost. The OVR bit is cleared by reading the SPICSR register. Write collision error (WCOL) A write collision occurs when the software tries to write to the SPIDR register while a data transfer is taking place with an external device. When this happens, the transfer continues uninterrupted and the software write is unsuccessful. Write collisions can occur both in master and slave mode. See also Slave select management on page98. Note: A read collision will never occur since the received data byte is placed in a buffer in which access is always synchronous with the MCU operation. The WCOL bit in the SPICSR register is set if a write collision occurs. No SPI interrupt is generated when the WCOL bit is set (the WCOL bit is a status flag only). A software sequence clears the WCOL bit (see Figure55). 102/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Figure 55. Clearing the WCOL bit (Write collision flag) software sequence Clearing sequence after SPIF = 1 (end of a data byte transfer) 1st Step Read SPICSR Result 2nd Step Read SPIDR SPIF =0 WCOL=0 Clearing sequence before SPIF = 1 (during a data byte transfer) 1st Step Read SPICSR Result Note: Writing to the SPIDR register 2nd Step Read SPIDR WCOL=0 instead of reading it does not reset the WCOL bit. Single master systems A typical single master system may be configured, using an MCU as the master and four MCUs as slaves (see Figure56). The master device selects the individual slave devices by using four pins of a parallel port to control the four SS pins of the slave devices. The SS pins are pulled high during reset since the master device ports will be forced to be inputs at that time, thus disabling the slave devices. Note: To prevent a bus conflict on the MISO line the master allows only one active slave device during a transmission. For more security, the slave device may respond to the master with the received data byte. Then the master will receive the previous byte back from the slave device if all MISO and MOSI pins are connected and the slave has not written to its SPIDR register. Other transmission security methods can use ports for handshake lines or data bytes with command fields. Figure 56. Single master/multiple slave configuration SS SS SS SS SCK SCK SCK SCK Slave Slave Slave Slave MCU MCU MCU MCU MOSI MISO MOSI MISO MOSI MISO MOSI MISO MOSI MISO SCK s Master ort P MCU 5V SS 103/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx 10.4.6 Low power modes T able 53. Effect of low power modes on SPI Mode Description No effect on SPI. Wait SPI interrupt events cause the device to exit from Wait mode. SPI registers are frozen. In Halt mode, the SPI is inactive. SPI operation resumes when the MCU is woken up by an interrupt with Exit from Halt mode capability. The data received is subsequently read from Halt the SPIDR register when the software is running (interrupt vector fetching). If several data are received before the wakeup event, then an overrun error is generated. This error can be detected after the fetch of the interrupt routine that woke up the device. Using the SPI to wake up the MCU from Halt mode In slave configuration, the SPI is able to wake up the ST7 device from Halt mode through a SPIF interrupt. The data received is subsequently read from the SPIDR register when the software is running (interrupt vector fetch). If multiple data transfers have been performed before software clears the SPIF bit, then the OVR bit is set by hardware. Note: When waking up from Halt mode, if the SPI remains in Slave mode, it is recommended to perform an extra communications cycle to bring the SPI from Halt mode state to normal state. If the SPI exits from Slave mode, it returns to normal state immediately. Caution: The SPI can wake up the ST7 from Halt mode only if the Slave Select signal (external SS pin or the SSI bit in the SPICSR register) is low when the ST7 enters Halt mode. Therefore, if Slave selection is configured as external (see Slave select management on page98), make sure the master drives a low level on the SS pin when the slave enters Halt mode. 10.4.7 Interrupts T able 54. SPI interrupt control/wakeup capability(1) Interrupt event Event flag Enable control bit Exit from Wait Exit from Halt SPI end of transfer event SPIF Yes Master mode fault event MODF SPIE Yes No Overrun error OVR 1. The SPI interrupt events are connected to the same interrupt vector (see Section7: Interrupts). They generate an interrupt if the corresponding Enable Control Bit is set and the interrupt mask in the CC register is reset (RIM instruction). 10.4.8 SPI registers SPI control register (SPICR) SPICR Reset value: 0000 xxxx (0xh) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SPIE SPE SPR2 MSTR CPOL CPHA SPR[1:0] R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W 104/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals T able 55. SPICR register description Bit Name Function Serial Peripheral Interrupt Enable This bit is set and cleared by software. 7 SPIE 0: Interrupt is inhibited. 1: An SPI interrupt is generated whenever SPIF=1, MODF=1 or OVR=1 in the SPICSR register. Serial Peripheral Output Enable This bit is set and cleared by software. It is also cleared by hardware when, in master mode, SS=0 (see Master mode fault (MODF) on page102). The SPE bit 6 SPE is cleared by reset, so the SPI peripheral is not initially connected to the external pins. 0: I/O pins free for general purpose I/O 1: SPI I/O pin alternate functions enabled Divider Enable This bit is set and cleared by software and is cleared by reset. It is used with the SPR[1:0] bits to set the baud rate. Refer to Table56: SPI master mode SCK 5 SPR2 frequency. 0: Divider by 2 enabled 1: Divider by 2 disabled Note: This bit has no effect in slave mode. Master mode This bit is set and cleared by software. It is also cleared by hardware when, in master mode, SS=0 (see Master mode fault (MODF) on page102). 4 MSTR 0: Slave mode 1: Master mode. The function of the SCK pin changes from an input to an output and the functions of the MISO and MOSI pins are reversed. Clock Polarity This bit is set and cleared by software. This bit determines the idle state of the serial Clock. The CPOL bit affects both the master and slave modes. 3 CPOL 0: SCK pin has a low level idle state 1: SCK pin has a high level idle state Note: If CPOL is changed at the communication byte boundaries, the SPI must be disabled by resetting the SPE bit. Clock Phase This bit is set and cleared by software. 2 CPHA 0: The first clock transition is the first data capture edge. 1: The second clock transition is the first capture edge. Note: The slave must have the same CPOL and CPHA settings as the master. Serial clock frequency These bits are set and cleared by software. Used with the SPR2 bit, they select 1:0 SPR[1:0] the baud rate of the SPI serial clock SCK output by the SPI in master mode (seeTable56). Note: These 2 bits have no effect in slave mode. T able 56. SPI master mode SCK frequency Serial clock SPR2 SPR1 SPR0 f /4 1 0 0 CPU f /8 0 0 0 CPU 105/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Table 56. SPI master mode SCK frequency (continued) Serial clock SPR2 SPR1 SPR0 f /16 0 0 1 CPU f /32 1 1 0 CPU f /64 0 1 0 CPU f /128 0 1 1 CPU SPI control/status register (SPICSR) SPICSR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SPIF WCOL OVR MODF Reserved SOD SSM SSI RO RO RO RO - R/W R/W R/W T able 57. SPICSR register description Bit Name Function Serial peripheral data transfer flag This bit is set by hardware when a transfer has been completed. An interrupt is generated if SPIE=1 in the SPICR register. It is cleared by a software sequence (an access to the SPICSR register followed by a write or a read to the SPIDR register). 7 SPIF 0: Data transfer is in progress or the flag has been cleared 1: Data transfer between the device and an external device has been completed. Note: While the SPIF bit is set, all writes to the SPIDR register are inhibited until the SPICSR register is read. Write collision status This bit is set by hardware when a write to the SPIDR register is done during a 6 WCOL transmit sequence. It is cleared by a software sequence (see Figure55). 0: No write collision occurred 1: A write collision has been detected. SPI Overrun error This bit is set by hardware when the byte currently being received in the shift register is ready to be transferred into the SPIDR register while SPIF = 1 (see Overrun 5 OVR condition (OVR) on page102). An interrupt is generated if SPIE = 1 in SPICR register. The OVR bit is cleared by software reading the SPICSR register. 0: No overrun error 1: Overrun error detected Mode fault flag This bit is set by hardware when the SS pin is pulled low in master mode (see Master mode fault (MODF) on page102). An SPI interrupt can be generated if SPIE=1 in the SPICSR register. This bit is cleared by a software sequence (An 4 MODF access to the SPICR register while MODF=1 followed by a write to the SPICR register). 0: No master mode fault detected 1: A fault in master mode has been detected. 3 - Reserved, must be kept cleared. 106/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Table 57. SPICSR register description (continued) Bit Name Function SPI output disable This bit is set and cleared by software. When set, it disables the alternate function of 2 SOD the SPI output (MOSI in master mode / MISO in slave mode). 0: SPI output enabled (if SPE=1). 1: SPI output disabled. SS management This bit is set and cleared by software. When set, it disables the alternate function of the SPI SS pin and uses the SSI bit value instead. See Slave select management on 1 SSM page98. 0: Hardware management (SS managed by external pin). 1: Software management (internal SS signal controlled by SSI bit. External SS pin free for general-purpose I/O). SS Internal mode This bit is set and cleared by software. It acts as a ‘chip select’ by controlling the 0 SSI level of the SS slave select signal when the SSM bit is set. 0: Slave selected. 1: Slave deselected. SPI data I/O register (SPIDR) SPIDR Reset value: undefined 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W The SPIDR register is used to transmit and receive data on the serial bus. In a master device, a write to this register will initiate transmission/reception of another byte. Note: During the last clock cycle the SPIF bit is set, a copy of the received data byte in the shift register is moved to a buffer. When the user reads the serial peripheral data I/O register, the buffer is actually being read. While the SPIF bit is set, all writes to the SPIDR register are inhibited until the SPICSR register is read. Warning: A write to the SPIDR register places data directly into the shift register for transmission. A read to the SPIDR register returns the value located in the buffer and not the content of the shift register (see Figure50). 107/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx T able 58. SPI register map and reset values Address (Hex.) Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SPIDR MSB LSB 0021h Reset value x x x x x x x x SPICR SPIE SPE SPR2 MSTR CPOL CPHA SPR1 SPR0 0022h Reset value 0 0 0 0 x x x x SPICSR SPIF WCOL OVR MODF SOD SSM SSI 0023h Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 10.5 Serial communications interface (SCI) 10.5.1 Introduction The serial communications interface (SCI) offers a flexible means of full-duplex data exchange with external equipment requiring an industry standard NRZ asynchronous serial data format. The SCI offers a very wide range of baud rates using two baud rate generator systems. 10.5.2 Main features ● Full duplex, asynchronous communications ● NRZ standard format (mark/space) ● Dual baud rate generator systems ● Independently programmable transmit and receive baud rates up to 500K baud. ● Programmable data word length (8 or 9 bits) ● Receive buffer full, Transmit buffer empty and End of Transmission flags ● 2 receiver wakeup modes – Address bit (MSB) – Idle line ● Muting function for multiprocessor configurations ● Separate enable bits for Transmitter and Receiver ● 4 error detection flags – Overrun error – Noise error – Frame error – Parity error ● 5 interrupt sources with flags – Transmit data register empty – Transmission complete – Receive data register full – Idle line received – Overrun error detected 108/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals ● Parity control – Transmits parity bit – Checks parity of received data byte ● Reduced power consumption mode 10.5.3 General description The interface is externally connected to another device by two pins (see Figure58): ● TDO: Transmit Data Output. When the transmitter and the receiver are disabled, the output pin returns to its I/O port configuration. When the transmitter and/or the receiver are enabled and nothing is to be transmitted, the TDO pin is at high level. ● RDI: Receive Data Input is the serial data input. Oversampling techniques are used for data recovery by discriminating between valid incoming data and noise. Through these pins, serial data is transmitted and received as frames comprising: ● an Idle Line prior to transmission or reception ● a start bit ● a data word (8 or 9 bits) least significant bit first ● a Stop bit indicating that the frame is complete This interface uses two types of baud rate generator: ● a conventional type for commonly-used baud rates ● an extended type with a prescaler offering a very wide range of baud rates even with non-standard oscillator frequencies 109/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Figure 57. SCI block diagram Write Read (Data Register) DR Transmit Data Register (TDR) Received Data Register (RDR) TDO Transmit Shift Register Received Shift Register RDI CR1 R8 T8 SCID M WAKE PCE PS PIE Wake Transmit up Receiver Receiver control unit control clock CR2 SR TIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK TDRE TC RDRFIDLE OR NF FE PE SCI Interrupt control Transmitter clock Transmitter rate control f CPU /16 /PR BRR SCP1SCP0SCT2SCT1SCT0SCR2SCR1SCR0 Receiver rate control Conventional baud rate generator 110/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 10.5.4 Functional description The block diagram of the serial control interface is shown in Figure57. It contains six dedicated registers: ● 2 control registers (SCICR1 and SCICR2) ● a status register (SCISR) ● a baud rate register (SCIBRR) ● an extended prescaler receiver register (SCIERPR) ● an extended prescaler transmitter register (SCIETPR) Refer to the register descriptions in Section10.5.7 for the definitions of each bit. Serial data format Word length may be selected as being either 8 or 9 bits by programming the M bit in the SCICR1 register (see Figure57). The TDO pin is in low state during the start bit. The TDO pin is in high state during the stop bit. An Idle character is interpreted as an entire frame of ‘1’s followed by the start bit of the next frame which contains data. A Break character is interpreted on receiving ‘0’s for some multiple of the frame period. At the end of the last break frame the transmitter inserts an extra ‘1’ bit to acknowledge the start bit. Transmission and reception are driven by their own baud rate generator. Figure 58. Word length programming 9-bit word length (M bit is set) Data frame Possible Next data frame Parity bit Next Start Start bit bit 0 bit 1 bit 2 bit 3 bit 4 bit 5 bit 6 bit 7 bit 8 Sbtiotp bit Start Idle frame bit Break frame Extra Start bit ’1’ 8-bit word length (M bit is reset) Data frame Possible Next data frame Parity bit Next Start Stop Start bit bit 0 bit 1 bit 2 bit 3 bit 4 bit 5 bit 6 bit 7 Bit bit Start Idle frame bit Extra Start Break frame ’1’ bit 111/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Transmitter The transmitter can send data words of either 8 or 9 bits depending on the M bit status. When the M bit is set, word length is 9 bits and the 9th bit (the MSB) has to be stored in the T8 bit in the SCICR1 register. Character transmission During an SCI transmission, data shifts out LSB first on the TDO pin. In this mode, the SCIDR register consists of a buffer (TDR) between the internal bus and the transmit shift register (see Figure57). Procedure 1. Select the M bit to define the word length. 2. Select the desired baud rate using the SCIBRR and the SCIETPR registers. 3. Set the TE bit to assign the TDO pin to the alternate function and to send a idle frame as first transmission. 4. Access the SCISR register and write the data to send in the SCIDR register (this sequence clears the TDRE bit). Repeat this sequence for each data to be transmitted. Clearing the TDRE bit is always performed by the following software sequence: 1. An access to the SCISR register 2. A write to the SCIDR register The TDRE bit is set by hardware and it indicates: ● The TDR register is empty. ● The data transfer is beginning. ● The next data can be written in the SCIDR register without overwriting the previous data. This flag generates an interrupt if the TIE bit is set and the I bit is cleared in the CCR register. When a transmission is taking place, a write instruction to the SCIDR register stores the data in the TDR register and which is copied in the shift register at the end of the current transmission. When no transmission is taking place, a write instruction to the SCIDR register places the data directly in the shift register, the data transmission starts, and the TDRE bit is immediately set. When a frame transmission is complete (after the stop bit) the TC bit is set and an interrupt is generated if the TCIE is set and the I bit is cleared in the CCR register. Clearing the TC bit is performed by the following software sequence: 1. An access to the SCISR register 2. A write to the SCIDR register Note: The TDRE and TC bits are cleared by the same software sequence. 112/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Break characters Setting the SBK bit loads the shift register with a break character. The break frame length depends on the M bit (see Figure58). As long as the SBK bit is set, the SCI send break frames to the TDO pin. After clearing this bit by software the SCI insert a logic 1 bit at the end of the last break frame to guarantee the recognition of the start bit of the next frame. Idle characters Setting the TE bit drives the SCI to send an idle frame before the first data frame. Clearing and then setting the TE bit during a transmission sends an idle frame after the current word. Note: Resetting and setting the TE bit causes the data in the TDR register to be lost. Therefore, the best time to toggle the TE bit is when the TDRE bit is set, that is, before writing the next byte in the SCIDR. Receiver The SCI can receive data words of either 8 or 9 bits. When the M bit is set, word length is 9 bits and the MSB is stored in the R8 bit in the SCICR1 register. Character reception During a SCI reception, data shifts in least significant bit first through the RDI pin. In this mode, the SCIDR register consists or a buffer (RDR) between the internal bus and the received shift register (see Figure57). Procedure 1. Select the M bit to define the word length. 2. Select the desired baud rate using the SCIBRR and the SCIERPR registers. 3. Set the RE bit, this enables the receiver which begins searching for a start bit. When a character is received: ● The RDRF bit is set. It indicates that the content of the shift register is transferred to the RDR. ● An interrupt is generated if the RIE bit is set and the I bit is cleared in the CCR register. ● The error flags can be set if a frame error, noise or an overrun error has been detected during reception. Clearing the RDRF bit is performed by the following software sequence done by: 1. An access to the SCISR register 2. A read to the SCIDR register. The RDRF bit must be cleared before the end of the reception of the next character to avoid an overrun error. Break character When a break character is received, the SCI handles it as a framing error. Idle character When a idle frame is detected, there is the same procedure as a data received character plus an interrupt if the ILIE bit is set and the I bit is cleared in the CCR register. 113/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Overrun error An overrun error occurs when a character is received when RDRF has not been reset. Data can not be transferred from the shift register to the RDR register as long as the RDRF bit is not cleared. When a overrun error occurs: ● The OR bit is set. ● The RDR content will not be lost. ● The shift register will be overwritten. ● An interrupt is generated if the RIE bit is set and the I bit is cleared in the CCR register. The OR bit is reset by an access to the SCISR register followed by a SCIDR register read operation. Noise error Oversampling techniques are used for data recovery by discriminating between valid incoming data and noise. Normal data bits are considered valid if three consecutive samples (8th, 9th, 10th) have the same bit value, otherwise the NF flag is set. In the case of start bit detection, the NF flag is set on the basis of an algorithm combining both valid edge detection and three samples (8th, 9th, 10th). Therefore, to prevent the NF flag from being set during start bit reception, there should be a valid edge detection as well as three valid samples. When noise is detected in a frame: ● The NF flag is set at the rising edge of the RDRF bit. ● Data is transferred from the Shift register to the SCIDR register. ● No interrupt is generated. However this bit rises at the same time as the RDRF bit which itself generates an interrupt. The NF flag is reset by a SCISR register read operation followed by a SCIDR register read operation. During reception, if a false start bit is detected (for example, 8th, 9th, 10th samples are 011,101,110), the frame is discarded and the receiving sequence is not started for this frame. There is no RDRF bit set for this frame and the NF flag is set internally (not accessible to the user). This NF flag is accessible along with the RDRF bit when a next valid frame is received. Note: If the application Start bit is not long enough to match the above requirements, then the NF Flag may get set due to the short Start bit. In this case, the NF flag may be ignored by the application software when the first valid byte is received. See also Noise error causes on page119. 114/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Figure 59. SCI baud rate and extended prescaler block diagram Transmitter clock Extended prescaler transmitter rate control SCIETPR Extended transmitter prescaler register SCIERPR Extended receiver prescaler register Receiver clock Extended prescaler receiver rate control Extended prescaler f CPU Transmitter rate control /16 /PR SCIBRR SCP1SCP0SCT2SCT1SCT0SCR2SCR1SCR0 Receiver rate control Conventional baud rate generator Framing error A framing error is detected when: ● The stop bit is not recognized on reception at the expected time, following either a de- synchronization or excessive noise. ● A break is received. When the framing error is detected: ● the FE bit is set by hardware ● Data is transferred from the Shift register to the SCIDR register. ● No interrupt is generated. However this bit rises at the same time as the RDRF bit which itself generates an interrupt. The FE bit is reset by a SCISR register read operation followed by a SCIDR register read operation. 115/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Conventional baud rate generation The baud rate for the receiver and transmitter (Rx and Tx) are set independently and calculated as follows: fCPU fCPU Tx = Rx = (16*PR)*TR (16*PR)*RR with: PR = 1, 3, 4 or 13 (see SCP[1:0] bits) TR = 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64,128 (see SCT[2:0] bits) RR = 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64,128 (see SCR[2:0] bits) All these bits are in the SCI baud rate register (SCIBRR) on page125. Example: If f is 8 MHz (normal mode) and if PR=13 and TR=RR=1, the transmit and CPU receive baud rates are 38400 baud. Note: The baud rate registers MUST NOT be changed while the transmitter or the receiver is enabled. Extended baud rate generation The extended prescaler option gives a very fine tuning on the baud rate, using a 255 value prescaler, whereas the conventional baud rate generator retains industry standard software compatibility. The extended baud rate generator block diagram is described in Figure59. The output clock rate sent to the transmitter or to the receiver will be the output from the 16 divider divided by a factor ranging from 1 to 255 set in the SCIERPR or the SCIETPR register. The extended prescaler is activated by setting the SCIETPR or SCIERPR register to a value other than zero. The baud rates are calculated as follows: fCPU fCPU Tx = Rx = 16*ETPR*(PR*TR) 16*ERPR*(PR*RR) with: ETPR = 1,..,255, see SCI extended transmit prescaler division register (SCIETPR) on page126. ERPR = 1,.. 255, see SCI extended receive prescaler division register (SCIERPR) on page125. 116/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Receiver muting and wakeup feature In multiprocessor configurations it is often desirable that only the intended message recipient should actively receive the full message contents, thus reducing redundant SCI service overhead for all non-addressed receivers. The non-addressed devices may be placed in sleep mode by means of the muting function. Setting the RWU bit by software puts the SCI in sleep mode: All the reception status bits cannot be set. All the receive interrupts are inhibited. A muted receiver may be awakened by one of the following two ways: ● by Idle Line detection if the Wake bit is reset, ● by Address Mark detection if the Wake bit is set. A receiver wakes up by Idle Line detection when the Receive line has recognized an Idle Frame. Then the RWU bit is reset by hardware but the Idle bit is not set. A receiver wakes up by Address Mark detection when it received a ‘1’ as the most significant bit of a word, thus indicating that the message is an address. The reception of this particular word wakes up the receiver, resets the RWU bit and sets the RDRF bit, which allows the receiver to receive this word normally and to use it as an address word. Caution: In Mute mode, do not write to the SCICR2 register. If the SCI is in Mute mode during the read operation (RWU=1) and an address mark wakeup event occurs (RWU is reset) before the write operation, the RWU bit will be set again by this write operation. Consequently the address byte is lost and the SCI is not woken up from Mute mode. Parity control Parity control (generation of parity bit in transmission and parity checking in reception) can be enabled by setting the PCE bit in the SCICR1 register. Depending on the frame length defined by the M bit, the possible SCI frame formats are as listed in Table59. T able 59. Frame formats(1)(2) M bit PCE bit SCI frame 0 0 | SB | 8 bit data | STB | 0 1 | SB | 7-bit data | PB | STB | 1 0 | SB | 9-bit data | STB | 1 1 | SB | 8-bit data PB | STB | 1. SB = Start bit, STB = Stop bit, and PB = Parity bit. 2. In case of wakeup by an address mark, the MSB bit of the data is taken into account and not the Parity bit. 117/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Even parity The parity bit is calculated to obtain an even number of ‘1’s inside the frame made of the 7 or 8 LSB bits (depending on whether M is equal to 0 or 1) and the parity bit, for example, data=00110101; 4 bits set => Parity bit will be 0 if Even parity is selected (PS bit=0). Odd parity The parity bit is calculated to obtain an odd number of ‘1’s inside the frame made of the 7 or 8 LSB bits (depending on whether M is equal to 0 or 1) and the parity bit, for example, data=00110101; 4 bits set => Parity bit will be 1 if Odd parity is selected (PS bit=1). Transmission mode If the PCE bit is set then the MSB bit of the data written in the data register is not transmitted but is changed by the parity bit. Reception mode If the PCE bit is set then the interface checks if the received data byte has an even number of ‘1’s if even parity is selected (PS=0) or an odd number of ‘1’s if odd parity is selected (PS=1). If the parity check fails, the PE flag is set in the SCISR register and an interrupt is generated if PIE is set in the SCICR1 register. SCI clock tolerance During reception, each bit is sampled 16 times. The majority of the 8th, 9th and 10th samples is considered as the bit value. For a valid bit detection, all the three samples should have the same value otherwise the noise flag (NF) is set. For example: If the 8th, 9th and 10th samples are 0, 1 and 1 respectively, then the bit value will be ‘1’, but the Noise flag bit is set because the three samples values are not the same. Consequently, the bit length must be long enough so that the 8th, 9th and 10th samples have the desired bit value. This means the clock frequency should not vary more than 6/16 (37.5%) within one bit. The sampling clock is resynchronized at each start bit, so that when receiving 10 bits (one start bit, 1 data byte, 1 stop bit), the clock deviation must not exceed 3.75%. Note: The internal sampling clock of the microcontroller samples the pin value on every falling edge. Therefore, the internal sampling clock and the time the application expects the sampling to take place may be out of sync. For example: If the baud rate is 15.625 kbaud (bit length is 64 µs), then the 8th, 9th and 10th samples will be at 28 µs, 32 µs and 36 µs respectively (the first sample starting ideally at 0 µs). But if the falling edge of the internal clock occurs just before the pin value changes, the samples would then be out of sync by ~4 µs. This means the entire bit length must be at least 40µs (36 µs for the 10th sample + 4 µs for synchronization with the internal sampling clock). 118/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Clock deviation causes The causes which contribute to the total deviation are: – D : Deviation due to transmitter error (local oscillator error of the transmitter or TRA the transmitter is transmitting at a different baud rate). – D : Error due to the baud rate quantization of the receiver. QUANT – D : Deviation of the local oscillator of the receiver: This deviation can occur REC during the reception of one complete SCI message assuming that the deviation has been compensated at the beginning of the message. – D : Deviation due to the transmission line (generally due to the transceivers) TCL All the deviations of the system should be added and compared to the SCI clock tolerance: D + D + D + D < 3.75% TRA QUANT REC TCL Noise error causes See also the description of Noise error in Receiver on page113. Start bit The Noise Flag (NF) is set during start bit reception if one of the following conditions occurs: 1. A valid falling edge is not detected. A falling edge is considered to be valid if the three consecutive samples before the falling edge occurs are detected as ‘1’ and, after the falling edge occurs, during the sampling of the 16 samples, if one of the samples numbered 3, 5 or 7 is detected as a ‘1’. 2. During sampling of the 16 samples, if one of the samples numbered 8, 9 or 10 is detected as a ‘1’. Therefore, a valid Start bit must satisfy both the above conditions to prevent the Noise Flag from being set. Data bits The Noise Flag (NF) is set during normal data bit reception if the following condition occurs: During the sampling of 16 samples, if all three samples numbered 8, 9 and10 are not the same. The majority of the 8th, 9th and 10th samples is considered as the bit value. Therefore, a valid Data bit must have samples 8, 9 and 10 at the same value to prevent the Noise Flag from being set. Figure 60. Bit sampling in Reception mode RDI line sampled values Sample clock 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 6/16 7/16 7/16 One bit time 119/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx 10.5.5 Low power modes T able 60. Effect of low power modes on SCI Mode Description No effect on SCI. Wait SCI interrupts cause the device to exit from Wait mode. SCI registers are frozen. Halt In Halt mode, the SCI stops transmitting/receiving until Halt mode is exited. 10.5.6 Interrupts The SCI interrupt events are connected to the same interrupt vector. These events generate an interrupt if the corresponding Enable Control bit is set and the interrupt mask in the CC register is reset (RIM instruction). T able 61. SCI interrupt control/wakeup capability Interrupt event Event flag Enable control bit Exit from Wait Exit from Halt Transmit data register empty TDRE TIE Yes No Transmission complete TC TCIE Yes No Received data ready to be read RDRF Yes No RIE Overrun error detected OR Yes No Idle line detected IDLE ILIE Yes No Parity error PE PIE Yes No 10.5.7 SCI registers SCI status register (SCISR) SCISR Reset value: 1100 0000 (C0h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TDRE TC RDRF IDLE OR NF FE PE RO RO RO RO RO RO RO RO T able 62. SCISR register description Bit Name Function Transmit Data Register Empty This bit is set by hardware when the content of the TDR register has been transferred into the shift register. An interrupt is generated if the TIE bit = 1 in the SCICR2 register. It is cleared by a software sequence (an access to the SCISR register 7 TDRE followed by a write to the SCIDR register). 0: Data is not transferred to the shift register. 1: Data is transferred to the shift register. Note: Data will not be transferred to the shift register unless the TDRE bit is cleared. 120/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Table 62. SCISR register description (continued) Bit Name Function Transmission complete This bit is set by hardware when transmission of a frame containing data is complete. An interrupt is generated if TCIE = 1 in the SCICR2 register. It is cleared by a software sequence (an access to the SCISR register followed by a write to the 6 TC SCIDR register). 0: Transmission is not complete 1: Transmission is complete Note: TC is not set after the transmission of a Preamble or a Break. Received data ready flag This bit is set by hardware when the content of the RDR register has been transferred to the SCIDR register. An interrupt is generated if RIE=1 in the SCICR2 5 RDRF register. It is cleared by a software sequence (an access to the SCISR register followed by a read to the SCIDR register). 0: Data is not received 1: Received data is ready to be read Idle line detect This bit is set by hardware when a Idle Line is detected. An interrupt is generated if the ILIE = 1 in the SCICR2 register. It is cleared by a software sequence (an access to the SCISR register followed by a read to the SCIDR register). 4 IDLE 0: No idle line is detected 1: Idle line is detected Note: The IDLE bit is not reset until the RDRF bit has itself been set (that is, a new idle line occurs). Overrun error This bit is set by hardware when the word currently being received in the shift register is ready to be transferred into the RDR register while RDRF = 1. An interrupt is generated if RIE = 1 in the SCICR2 register. It is cleared by a software sequence (an 3 OR access to the SCISR register followed by a read to the SCIDR register). 0: No overrun error 1: Overrun error is detected Note: When this bit is set RDR register content is not lost but the shift register is overwritten. Noise flag This bit is set by hardware when noise is detected on a received frame. It is cleared by a software sequence (an access to the SCISR register followed by a read to the SCIDR register). 2 NF 0: No noise is detected 1: Noise is detected Note: This bit does not generate interrupt as it appears at the same time as the RDRF bit which itself generates an interrupt. Framing error This bit is set by hardware when a desynchronization, excessive noise or a break character is detected. It is cleared by a software sequence (an access to the SCISR register followed by a read to the SCIDR register). 0: No framing error is detected 1 FE 1: Framing error or break character is detected Note: This bit does not generate interrupt as it appears at the same time as the RDRF bit which itself generates an interrupt. If the word currently being transferred causes both Frame Error and Overrun error, it is transferred and only the OR bit will be set. 121/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Table 62. SCISR register description (continued) Bit Name Function Parity error This bit is set by hardware when a parity error occurs in receiver mode. It is cleared by a software sequence (a read to the status register followed by an access to the 0 PE SCIDR data register). An interrupt is generated if PIE = 1 in the SCICR1 register. 0: No parity error 1: Parity error SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1) SCICR1 Reset value: x000 0000 (x0h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R8 T8 SCID M WAKE PCE PS PIE R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W T able 63. SCICR1 register description Bit Name Function Receive data bit 8 7 R8 This bit is used to store the 9th bit of the received word when M = 1. Transmit data bit 8 6 T8 This bit is used to store the 9th bit of the transmitted word when M = 1. Disabled for low power consumption When this bit is set the SCI prescalers and outputs are stopped and the end of the current byte transfer in order to reduce power consumption.This bit is set and 5 SCID cleared by software. 0: SCI enabled 1: SCI prescaler and outputs disabled Word length This bit determines the word length. It is set or cleared by software. 0: 1 Start bit, 8 data bits, 1 Stop bit 4 M 1: 1 Start bit, 9 data bits, 1 Stop bit Note: The M bit must not be modified during a data transfer (both transmission and reception). Wakeup method This bit determines the SCI wakeup method, it is set or cleared by software. 3 WAKE 0: Idle line 1: Address mark Parity control enable This bit selects the hardware parity control (generation and detection). When the parity control is enabled, the computed parity is inserted at the MSB position (9th bit if M = 1; 8th bit if M = 0) and parity is checked on the received data. This bit is set 2 PCE and cleared by software. Once it is set, PCE is active after the current byte (in reception and in transmission). 0: Parity control disabled 1: Parity control enabled 122/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Table 63. SCICR1 register description (continued) Bit Name Function Parity selection This bit selects the odd or even parity when the parity generation/detection is enabled (PCE bit set). It is set and cleared by software. The parity will be selected 1 PS after the current byte. 0: Even parity 1: Odd parity Parity interrupt enable This bit enables the interrupt capability of the hardware parity control when a parity 0 PIE error is detected (PE bit set). It is set and cleared by software. 0: Parity error interrupt disabled 1: Parity error interrupt enabled SCI control register 2 (SCICR2) SCICR2 Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W T able 64. SCICR2 register description Bit Name Function Transmitter interrupt enable This bit is set and cleared by software. 7 TIE 0: Interrupt is inhibited 1: An SCI interrupt is generated whenever TDRE = 1 in the SCISR register. Transmission complete interrupt enable This bit is set and cleared by software. 6 TCIE 0: Interrupt is inhibited 1: An SCI interrupt is generated whenever TC = 1 in the SCISR register. Receiver interrupt enable This bit is set and cleared by software. 5 RIE 0: Interrupt is inhibited 1: An SCI interrupt is generated whenever OR = 1 or RDRF = 1 in the SCISR register. Idle line interrupt enable This bit is set and cleared by software. 4 ILIE 0: Interrupt is inhibited 1: An SCI interrupt is generated whenever IDLE=1 in the SCISR register. 123/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Table 64. SCICR2 register description (continued) Bit Name Function Transmitter enable This bit enables the transmitter. It is set and cleared by software. 0: Transmitter is disabled 1: Transmitter is enabled Notes: 3 TE - During transmission, a ‘0’ pulse on the TE bit (‘0’ followed by ‘1’) sends a preamble (Idle line) after the current word. - When TE is set there is a 1 bit-time delay before the transmission starts. Caution: The TDO pin is free for general purpose I/O only when the TE and RE bits are both cleared (or if TE is never set). Receiver enable This bit enables the receiver. It is set and cleared by software. 0: Receiver is disabled 2 RE 1: Receiver is enabled and begins searching for a start bit Note: Before selecting Mute mode (setting the RWU bit), the SCI must first receive some data, otherwise it cannot function in Mute mode with wakeup by Idle line detection. Receiver wakeup This bit determines if the SCI is in mute mode or not. It is set and cleared by 1 RWU software and can be cleared by hardware when a wakeup sequence is recognized. 0: Receiver in Active mode 1: Receiver in Mute mode Send break This bit set is used to send break characters. It is set and cleared by software. 0: No break character is transmitted. 0 SBK 1: Break characters are transmitted. Note: If the SBK bit is set to ‘1’ and then to ‘0’, the transmitter will send a Break word at the end of the current word. SCI data register (SCIDR) This register contains the received or transmitted data character, depending on whether it is read from or written to. SCIDR Reset value: undefined 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DR7 DR6 DR5 DR4 DR3 DR2 DR1 DR0 R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W The Data register performs a double function (read and write) since it is composed of two registers, one for transmission (TDR) and one for reception (RDR). The TDR register provides the parallel interface between the internal bus and the output shift register (see Figure57). The RDR register provides the parallel interface between the input shift register and the internal bus (see Figure57). 124/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals SCI baud rate register (SCIBRR) SCIBRR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SCP[1:0] SCT[2:0] SCR[2:0] R/W R/W R/W T able 65. SCIBRR register description Bit Name Function First SCI prescaler These 2 prescaling bits allow several standard clock division ranges. 00: PR prescaling factor=1 7:6 SCP[1:0] 01: PR prescaling factor=3 10: PR prescaling factor=4 11: PR prescaling factor=13 SCI Transmitter rate divisor These 3 bits, in conjunction with the SCP1 and SCP0 bits, define the total division applied to the bus clock to yield the transmit rate clock in conventional baud rate generator mode. 000: TR dividing factor=1 001: TR dividing factor=2 5:3 SCT[2:0] 010: TR dividing factor=4 011: TR dividing factor=8 100: TR dividing factor=16 101: TR dividing factor=32 110: TR dividing factor=64 111: TR dividing factor=128 SCI Receiver rate divisor These 3 bits, in conjunction with the SCP[1:0] bits, define the total division applied to the bus clock to yield the receive rate clock in conventional baud rate generator mode. 000: RR dividing factor=1 001: RR dividing factor=2 2:0 SCR[2:0] 010: RR dividing factor=4 011: RR dividing factor=8 100: RR dividing factor=16 101: RR dividing factor=32 110: RR dividing factor=64 111: RR dividing factor=128 SCI extended receive prescaler division register (SCIERPR) This register is used to set the Extended Prescaler rate division factor for the receive circuit. SCIERPR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ERPR[7:0] R/W 125/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx T able 66. SCIERPR register description Bit Name Function 8-bit extended receive prescaler register The extended baud rate generator is activated when a value different from 00h is stored in this register. Therefore the clock frequency issued from the 16 7:0 ERPR[7:0] divider (see Figure59) is divided by the binary factor set in the SCIERPR register (in the range 1 to 255). The extended baud rate generator is not used after a reset. SCI extended transmit prescaler division register (SCIETPR) This register is used to set the External Prescaler rate division factor for the transmit circuit. SCIETPR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ETPR[7:0] R/W T able 67. SCIETPR register description Bit Name Function 8-bit Extended Transmit Prescaler Register The extended baud rate generator is activated when a value different from 00h is stored in this register. Therefore the clock frequency issued from the 16 7:0 ETPR[7:0] divider (see Figure59) is divided by the binary factor set in the SCIETPR register (in the range 1 to 255). The extended baud rate generator is not used after a reset. Table 68. B aud rate selection Conditions Symbol Parameter Standard Baud rate Unit Accuracy vs. f Prescaler CPU Standard Conventional mode TR (or RR)=128, PR=13 300 ~300.48 TR (or RR)=32, PR=13 1200 ~1201.92 TR (or RR)=16, PR=13 2400 ~2403.84 ~0.16% TR (or RR)=8, PR=13 4800 ~4807.69 f Communication TR (or RR)=4, PR=13 9600 ~9615.38 fTx frequency 8MHz TR (or RR)=16, PR=3 10400 ~10416.67 Hz Rx TR (or RR)=2, PR=13 19200 ~19230.77 TR (or RR)=1, PR=13 38400 ~38461.54 Extended mode ~0.79% ETPR (or ERPR) = 35, 14400 ~14285.71 TR (or RR)=1, PR = 1 126/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Table 69. S CI register map and reset values Address (Hex.) Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SCISR TDRE TC RDRF IDLE OR NF FE PE 0050h Reset value 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 SCIDR MSB LSB 0051h Reset value x x x x x x x x SCIBRR SCP1 SCP0 SCT2 SCT1 SCT0 SCR2 SCR1 SCR0 0052h Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SCICR1 R8 T8 SCID M WAKE PCE PS PIE 0053h Reset value x 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SCICR2 TIE TCIE RIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK 0054h Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SCIERPR MSB LSB 0055h Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SCIPETPR MSB LSB 0057h Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 127/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx 10.6 10-bit A/D converter (ADC) 10.6.1 Introduction The on-chip analog-to-digital converter (ADC) peripheral is a 10-bit, successive approximation converter with internal sample and hold circuitry. This peripheral has up to 16 multiplexed analog input channels (refer to device pin out description) that allow the peripheral to convert the analog voltage levels from up to 16 different sources. The result of the conversion is stored in a 10-bit Data Register. The A/D converter is controlled through a Control/Status Register. 10.6.2 Main features ● 10-bit conversion ● Up to 16 channels with multiplexed input ● Linear successive approximation ● Data register (DR) which contains the results ● Conversion complete status flag ● On/off bit (to reduce consumption) The block diagram is shown in Figure61. Figure 61. ADC block diagram f CPU Div4 0 f ADC Div2 1 EOC SPEEDADON 0 CH3 CH2 CH1 CH0 ADCCSR 4 AIN0 AIN1 Analog AnalogtoDigital MUX Converter AINx ADCDRH D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 ADCDRL 0 0 0 0 0 0 D1 D0 128/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals 10.6.3 Functional description The conversion is monotonic, meaning that the result never decreases if the analog input does not increase. If the input voltage (V ) is greater than V (high-level voltage reference) then the AIN AREF conversion result is FFh in the ADCDRH register and 03h in the ADCDRL register (without overflow indication). If the input voltage (V ) is lower than V (low-level voltage reference) then the AIN SSA conversion result in the ADCDRH and ADCDRL registers is 00 00h. The A/D converter is linear and the digital result of the conversion is stored in the ADCDRH and ADCDRL registers. The accuracy of the conversion is described in the Electrical Characteristics Section. R is the maximum recommended impedance for an analog input signal. If the impedance AIN is too high, this will result in a loss of accuracy due to leakage and sampling not being completed in the allotted time. A/D converter configuration The analog input ports must be configured as input, no pull-up, no interrupt. Refer to Section9: I/O ports. Using these pins as analog inputs does not affect the ability of the port to be read as a logic input. In the ADCCSR register: Select the CS[3:0] bits to assign the analog channel to convert. Starting the conversion In the ADCCSR register: Set the ADON bit to enable the A/D converter and to start the conversion. From this time on, the ADC performs a continuous conversion of the selected channel. When a conversion is complete: – the EOC bit is set by hardware – the result is in the ADCDR registers A read to the ADCDRH or a write to any bit of the ADCCSR register resets the EOC bit. To read the 10 bits, perform the following steps: 1. Poll the EOC bit. 2. Read the ADCDRL register 3. Read the ADCDRH register. This clears EOC automatically. Note: The data is not latched, so both the low and the high data register must be read before the next conversion is complete. Therefore, it is recommended to disable interrupts while reading the conversion result. To read only 8 bits, perform the following steps: 1. Poll the EOC bit. 2. Read the ADCDRH register. This clears EOC automatically. 129/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx Changing the conversion channel The application can change channels during conversion. When software modifies the CH[3:0] bits in the ADCCSR register, the current conversion is stopped, the EOC bit is cleared, and the A/D converter starts converting the newly selected channel. 10.6.4 Low power modes Note: The A/D converter may be disabled by resetting the ADON bit. This feature allows reduced power consumption when no conversion is needed. T a. ble 70. Effect of low power modes on ADC Mode Description Wait No effect on A/D converter. A/D converter disabled. After wakeup from Halt mode, the A/D converter requires a stabilization time t Halt STAB (see Section12: Electrical characteristics) before accurate conversions can be performed. 10.6.5 Interrupts None. 10.6.6 ADC registers ADC control/status register (ADCCSR) ADCCSR Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 EOC SPEED ADON Reserved CH[3:0] RO R/W RW - RW T able 71. ADCCSR register description Bit Name Function End of Conversion This bit is set by hardware. It is cleared by hardware when software reads the 7 EOC ADCDRH register or writes to any bit of the ADCCSR register. 0: Conversion is not complete 1: Conversion complete ADC clock selection This bit is set and cleared by software. 6 SPEED 0: f = f /4 ADC CPU 1: f = f /2 ADC CPU A/D Converter on This bit is set and cleared by software. 5 ADON 0: Disable ADC and stop conversion 1: Enable ADC and start conversion 130/193

ST72324Bxx On-chip peripherals Table 71. ADCCSR register description (continued) Bit Name Function 4 - Reserved, must be kept cleared. Channel selection These bits are set and cleared by software. They select the analog input to convert. 0000: Channel pin=AIN0 0001: Channel pin=AIN1 0010: Channel pin=AIN2 0011: Channel pin=AIN3 0100: Channel pin=AIN4 0101: Channel pin=AIN5 0110: Channel pin=AIN6 0111: Channel pin=AIN7 3:0 CH[3:0] 1000: Channel pin=AIN8 1001: Channel pin=AIN9 1010: Channel pin=AIN10 1011: Channel pin=AIN11 1100: Channel pin=AIN12 1101: Channel pin=AIN13 1110: Channel pin=AIN14 1111: Channel pin=AIN15 Note: The number of channels is device dependent. Refer to Section2: Pin description. ADC data register high (ADCDRH) ADCDRH Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 D[9:2] RO T able 72. ADCDRH register description Bit Name Function 7:0 D[9:2] MSB of converted analog value 131/193

On-chip peripherals ST72324Bxx ADC data register low (ADCDRL) ADCDRL Reset value: 0000 0000 (00h) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Reserved D[1:0] - RO T able 73. ADCDRL register description Bit Name Function 7:2 - Reserved. Forced by hardware to 0. 1:0 D[1:0] LSB of converted analog value T able 74. ADC register map and reset values Address (Hex.) Register label 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADCCSR EOC SPEED ADON CH3 CH2 CH1 CH0 0070h Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADCDRH D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 0071h Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADCDRL D1 D0 0072h Reset value 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 132/193

ST72324Bxx Instruction set 11 Instruction set 11.1 CPU addressing modes The CPU features 17 different addressing modes which can be classified in 7 main groups (see Table75). T a: ble 75. Addressing mode groups Addressing mode Example Inherent nop Immediate ld A,#$55 Direct ld A,$55 Indexed ld A,($55,X) Indirect ld A,([$55],X) Relative jrne loop Bit operation bset byte,#5 The CPU Instruction Set is designed to minimize the number of bytes required per instruction: To do so, most of the addressing modes may be divided in two submodes called long and short: ● Long addressing mode is more powerful because it can use the full 64 Kbyte address space, however it uses more bytes and more CPU cycles. ● Short addressing mode is less powerful because it can generally only access page zero (0000h - 00FFh range), but the instruction size is more compact, and faster. All memory to memory instructions use short addressing modes only (CLR, CPL, NEG, BSET, BRES, BTJT, BTJF, INC, DEC, RLC, RRC, SLL, SRL, SRA, SWAP) The ST7 Assembler optimizes the use of long and short addressing modes. Table 76. C PU addressing mode overview Pointer address Pointer size Length Mode Syntax Destination (Hex.) (Hex.) (bytes) Inherent nop + 0 Immediate ld A,#$55 + 1 Short Direct ld A,$10 00..FF + 1 Long Direct ld A,$1000 0000..FFFF + 2 No offset Direct Indexed ld A,(X) 00..FF + 0 Short Direct Indexed ld A,($10,X) 00..1FE + 1 Long Direct Indexed ld A,($1000,X) 0000..FFFF + 2 Short Indirect ld A,[$10] 00..FF 00..FF byte + 2 Long Indirect ld A,[$10.w] 0000..FFFF 00..FF word + 2 Short Indirect Indexed ld A,([$10],X) 00..1FE 00..FF byte + 2 Long Indirect Indexed ld A,([$10.w],X) 0000..FFFF 00..FF word + 2 133/193

Instruction set ST72324Bxx Table 76. CPU addressing mode overview (continued) Relative Direct jrne loop PC+/-127 + 1 Relative Indirect jrne [$10] PC+/-127 00..FF byte + 2 Bit Direct bset $10,#7 00..FF + 1 Bit Indirect bset [$10],#7 00..FF 00..FF byte + 2 Bit Direct Relative btjt $10,#7,skip 00..FF + 2 Bit Indirect Relative btjt [$10],#7,skip 00..FF 00..FF byte + 3 11.1.1 Inherent All Inherent instructions consist of a single byte. The opcode fully specifies all the required information for the CPU to process the operation. T able 77. Inherent instructions Instruction Function NOP No operation TRAP S/W interrupt WFI Wait for interrupt (low power mode) HALT Halt oscillator (lowest power mode) RET Sub-routine return IRET Interrupt sub-routine return SIM Set interrupt mask (level 3) RIM Reset interrupt mask (level 0) SCF Set carry flag RCF Reset carry flag RSP Reset stack pointer LD Load CLR Clear PUSH/POP Push/Pop to/from the stack INC/DEC Increment/decrement TNZ Test negative or zero CPL, NEG 1 or 2 complement MUL Byte multiplication SLL, SRL, SRA, RLC, RRC Shift and rotate operations SWAP Swap nibbles 11.1.2 Immediate Immediate instructions have two bytes: The first byte contains the opcode and the second byte contains the operand value. 134/193

ST72324Bxx Instruction set T a. ble 78. Immediate instructions Instruction Function LD Load CP Compare BCP Bit compare AND, OR, XOR Logical operations ADC, ADD, SUB, SBC Arithmetic operations 11.1.3 Direct In Direct instructions, the operands are referenced by their memory address. The direct addressing mode consists of two submodes: Direct (short) The address is a byte, thus requiring only one byte after the opcode, but only allows 00-FF addressing space. Direct (long) The address is a word, thus allowing 64 Kbyte addressing space, but requires 2 bytes after the opcode. 11.1.4 Indexed (no offset, short, long) In this mode, the operand is referenced by its memory address, which is defined by the unsigned addition of an index register (X or Y) with an offset. The indexed addressing mode consists of three submodes: Indexed (no offset) There is no offset, (no extra byte after the opcode), and it allows 00-FF addressing space. Indexed (short) The offset is a byte, thus requiring only one byte after the opcode and allows 00 - 1FE addressing space. Indexed (long) The offset is a word, thus allowing 64 Kbyte addressing space and requires 2 bytes after the opcode. 11.1.5 Indirect (short, long) The required data byte to do the operation is found by its memory address, located in memory (pointer). The pointer address follows the opcode. The indirect addressing mode consists of two submodes: 135/193

Instruction set ST72324Bxx Indirect (short) The pointer address is a byte, the pointer size is a byte, thus allowing 00 - FF addressing space, and requires 1 byte after the opcode. Indirect (long) The pointer address is a byte, the pointer size is a word, thus allowing 64 Kbyte addressing space, and requires 1 byte after the opcode. 11.1.6 Indirect indexed (short, long) This is a combination of indirect and short indexed addressing modes. The operand is referenced by its memory address, which is defined by the unsigned addition of an index register value (X or Y) with a pointer value located in memory. The pointer address follows the opcode. The indirect indexed addressing mode consists of two submodes: Indirect indexed (short) The pointer address is a byte, the pointer size is a byte, thus allowing 00 - 1FE addressing space, and requires 1 byte after the opcode. Indirect indexed (long) The pointer address is a byte, the pointer size is a word, thus allowing 64 Kbyte addressing space, and requires 1 byte after the opcode. T Iable 79. Instructions supporting direct, indexed, indirect and indirect indexed addressing modes Instructions Function LD Load CP Compare Long and short AND, OR, XOR Logical operations ADC, ADD, SUB, SBC Arithmetic additions/subtractions operations BCP Bit Compare CLR Clear INC, DEC Increment/decrement TNZ Test negative or zero CPL, NEG 1 or 2 complement Short only BSET, BRES Bit operations BTJT, BTJF Bit test and jump operations SLL, SRL, SRA, RLC, RRC Shift and rotate operations SWAP Swap nibbles CALL, JP Call or jump sub-routine 136/193

ST72324Bxx Instruction set 11.1.7 Relative mode (direct, indirect) This addressing mode is used to modify the PC register value, by adding an 8-bit signed offset to it. T a. ble 80. Relative direct and indirect instructions and functions Available relative direct/indirect instructions Function JRxx Conditional Jump CALLR Call Relative The relative addressing mode consists of two submodes: Relative (direct) The offset follows the opcode. Relative (indirect) The offset is defined in the memory, the address of which follows the opcode. 11.2 Instruction groups The ST7 family devices use an Instruction Set consisting of 63 instructions. The instructions may be subdivided into 13 main groups as illustrated in the following table: T able 81. Instruction groups Group Instructions Load and transfer LD CLR Stack operation PUSH POP RSP Increment/decrement INC DEC Compare and tests CP TNZ BCP Logical operations AND OR XOR CPL NEG Bit operation BSET BRES Conditional bit test and branch BTJT BTJF Arithmetic operations ADC ADD SUB SBC MUL Shift and rotates SLL SRL SRA RLC RRC SWAP SLA Unconditional jump or call JRA JRT JRF JP CALL CALLR NOP RET Conditional branch JRxx Interruption management TRAP WFI HALT IRET Condition code flag modification SIM RIM SCF RCF 137/193

Instruction set ST72324Bxx Using a prebyte The instructions are described with one to four opcodes. In order to extend the number of available opcodes for an 8-bit CPU (256 opcodes), three different prebyte opcodes are defined. These prebytes modify the meaning of the instruction they precede. The whole instruction becomes: PC-2 End of previous instruction PC-1 Prebyte PC Opcode PC+1 Additional word (0 to 2) according to the number of bytes required to compute the effective address These prebytes enable the instruction in Y as well as indirect addressing modes to be implemented. They precede the opcode of the instruction in X or the instruction using direct addressing mode. The prebytes are: PDY 90 Replace an X based instruction using immediate, direct, indexed, or inherent addressing mode by a Y one. PIX 92 Replace an instruction using direct, direct bit, or direct relative addressing mode to an instruction using the corresponding indirect addressing mode. It also changes an instruction using X indexed addressing mode to an instruction using indirect X indexed addressing mode. PIY 91 Replace an instruction using X indirect indexed addressing mode by a Y one. 138/193

ST72324Bxx Instruction set Table 82. I n struction set overview Mnemo Description Function/example Dst Src I1 H I0 N Z C ADC Add with Carry A = A + M + C A M H N Z C ADD Addition A = A + M A M H N Z C AND Logical And A = A . M A M N Z BCP Bit compare A, memory tst (A . M) A M N Z BRES Bit reset bres Byte, #3 M BSET Bit set bset Byte, #3 M BTJF Jump if bit is false (0) btjf Byte, #3, Jmp1 M C BTJT Jump if bit is true (1) btjt Byte, #3, Jmp1 M C CALL Call sub-routine CALLR Call sub-routine relative CLR Clear reg, M 0 1 CP Arithmetic Compare tst(Reg - M) reg M N Z C CPL One Complement A = FFH-A reg, M N Z 1 DEC Decrement dec Y reg, M N Z HALT Halt 1 0 IRET Interrupt routine return Pop CC, A, X, PC I1 H I0 N Z C INC Increment inc X reg, M N Z JP Absolute Jump jp [TBL.w] JRA Jump relative always JRT Jump relative JRF Never jump jrf * JRIH Jump if ext. INT pin = 1 (ext. INT pin high) JRIL Jump if ext. INT pin = 0 (ext. INT pin low) JRH Jump if H = 1 H = 1 ? JRNH Jump if H = 0 H = 0 ? JRM Jump if I1:0 = 11 I1:0 = 11 ? JRNM Jump if I1:0 <> 11 I1:0 <> 11 ? JRMI Jump if N = 1 (minus) N = 1 ? JRPL Jump if N = 0 (plus) N = 0 ? JREQ Jump if Z = 1 (equal) Z = 1 ? JRNE Jump if Z = 0 (not equal) Z = 0 ? JRC Jump if C = 1 C = 1 ? JRNC Jump if C = 0 C = 0 ? JRULT Jump if C = 1 Unsigned < JRUGE Jump if C = 0 Jmp if unsigned >= 139/193

Instruction set ST72324Bxx Table 82. Instruction set overview (continued) Mnemo Description Function/example Dst Src I1 H I0 N Z C JRUGT Jump if (C + Z = 0) Unsigned > JRULE Jump if (C + Z = 1) Unsigned <= LD Load dst <=src reg, M M, reg N Z MUL Multiply X,A = X * A A, X, Y X, Y, A 0 0 NEG Negate (2's compl) neg $10 reg, M N Z C NOP No Operation OR OR operation A = A + M A M N Z pop reg reg M POP Pop from the Stack pop CC CC M I1 H I0 N Z C PUSH Push onto the Stack push Y M reg, CC RCF Reset carry flag C = 0 0 RIM Enable Interrupts I1:0 = 10 (level 0) 1 0 RLC Rotate Left true C C <= A <= C reg, M N Z C RRC Rotate Right true C C => A => C reg, M N Z C RSP Reset Stack Pointer S = Max allowed SBC Subtract with Carry A = A - M - C A M N Z C SCF Set CARRY FLAG C = 1 1 SIM Disable Interrupts I1:0 = 11 (level 3) 1 1 SLA Shift Left Arithmetic C <= A <= 0 reg, M N Z C SLL Shift Left Logic C <= A <= 0 reg, M N Z C SRL Shift Right Logic 0 => A => C reg, M 0 Z C SRA Shift Right Arithmetic A7 => A => C reg, M N Z C SUB Subtraction A = A - M A M N Z C SWAP SWAP nibbles A7-A4 <=> A3-A0 reg, M N Z TNZ Test for Neg and Zero tnz lbl1 N Z TRAP S/W TRAP S/W interrupt 1 1 WFI Wait for Interrupt 1 0 XOR Exclusive OR A = A XOR M A M N Z 140/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12 Electrical characteristics 12.1 Parameter conditions Unless otherwise specified, all voltages are referred to V . SS 12.1.1 Minimum and maximum values Unless otherwise specified the minimum and maximum values are guaranteed in the worst conditions of ambient temperature, supply voltage and frequencies by tests in production on 100% of the devices with an ambient temperature at T =25°C and T =T max (given by A A A the selected temperature range). Data based on characterization results, design simulation and/or technology characteristics are indicated in the table footnotes and are not tested in production. Based on characterization, the minimum and maximum values refer to sample tests and represent the mean value plus or minus three times the standard deviation (mean ±3Σ). 12.1.2 Typical values Unless otherwise specified, typical data are based on T =25 °C, V =5 V. They are given A DD only as design guidelines and are not tested. 12.1.3 Typical curves Unless otherwise specified, all typical curves are given only as design guidelines and are not tested. 12.1.4 Loading capacitor The loading conditions used for pin parameter measurement are shown in Figure62. Figure 62. Pin loading conditions ST7pin CL 141/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.1.5 Pin input voltage The input voltage measurement on a pin of the device is described in Figure63. Figure 63. Pin input voltage ST7pin VIN 12.2 Absolute maximum ratings Stresses above those listed as “absolute maximum ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device under these conditions is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. 12.2.1 Voltage characteristics T a ble 83. Voltage characteristics Symbol Ratings Maximum value Unit V - V Supply voltage 6.5 DD SS V - V Programming voltage 13 PP SS Input voltage on true open drain pin V -0.3 to 6.5 V SS VIN(1)(2) Input voltage on any other pin VSS-0.3 to V +0.3 DD |ΔV | and |ΔV | Variations between different digital power pins 50 DDx SSx mV |V - V | Variations between digital and analog ground pins 50 SSA SSx VESD(HBM) Electrostatic discharge voltage (human body model) see Section12.8.3 on V Electrostatic discharge voltage (machine model) page 157 ESD(MM) 1. Directly connecting the RESET and I/O pins to V or V could damage the device if an unintentional DD SS internal reset is generated or an unexpected change of the I/O configuration occurs (for example, due to a corrupted program counter). To guarantee safe operation, this connection has to be done through a pull-up or pull-down resistor (typical: 4.7 kΩ for RESET, 10 kΩ for I/Os). For the same reason, unused I/O pins must not be directly tied to V or V . DD SS 2. I must never be exceeded. This is implicitly ensured if V maximum is respected. If V maximum INJ(PIN) IN IN cannot be respected, the injection current must be limited externally to the I value. A positive INJ(PIN) injection is induced by V > V while a negative injection is induced by V < V . For true open-drain IN DD IN SS pads, there is no positive injection current, and the corresponding V maximum must always be IN respected. 142/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12.2.2 Current characteristics T a ble 84. Current characteristics Symbol Ratings Max value Unit 32-pin devices 75 I Total current into V power lines (source)(1) VDD DD 44-pin devices 150 32-pin devices 75 I Total current out of V ground lines (sink)(1) VSS SS 44-pin devices 150 Output current sunk by any standard I/O and control pin 20 I Output current sunk by any high sink I/O pin 40 IO Output current source by any I/Os and control pin - 25 mA Injected current on V pin ± 5 PP Injected current on RESET pin ± 5 Injected current on OSC1 and OSC2 pins ± 5 I (2)(3) INJ(PIN) Injected current on ROM and 32Kbyte Flash devices PB0 pin ± 5 Injected current on 8/16Kbyte Flash devices PB0 pin +5 Injected current on any other pin(4)(5) ± 5 ΣI (2) Total injected current (sum of all I/O and control pins)(4) ± 25 INJ(PIN) 1. All power (V ) and ground (V ) lines must always be connected to the external supply. DD SS 2. I must never be exceeded. This is implicitly insured if V maximum is respected. If V maximum INJ(PIN) IN IN cannot be respected, the injection current must be limited externally to the I value. A positive INJ(PIN) injection is induced by V > V while a negative injection is induced by V < V . For true open-drain IN DD IN SS pads, there is no positive injection current, and the corresponding V maximum must always be respected. IN 3. Negative injection degrades the analog performance of the device. See note in Section12.13.3: ADC accuracy on page171. If the current injection limits given in Table106: General characteristics on page158 are exceeded, general device malfunction may result. 4. When several inputs are submitted to a current injection, the maximum SI is the absolute sum of the INJ(PIN) positive and negative injected currents (instantaneous values). These results are based on characterization with SI maximum current injection on four I/O port pins of the device. INJ(PIN) 5. True open drain I/O port pins do not accept positive injection. 12.2.3 Thermal characteristics T a ble 85. Thermal characteristics Symbol Ratings Value Unit T Storage temperature range -65 to +150 °C STG T Maximum junction temperature (see Section13.3: Thermal characteristics) J 143/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.3 Operating conditions T able 86. Operating conditions Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit f Internal clock frequency 0 8 MHz CPU Operating voltage (except Flash Write/Erase) 3.8 5.5 V V DD Operating Voltage for Flash Write/Erase V = 11.4 to 12.6 V 4.5 5.5 PP 1-suffix version 0 70 5-suffix version -10 85 T Ambient temperature range 6-suffix version -40 85 °C A 7-suffix version -40 105 3-suffix version -40 125 Figure 64. f max versus V CPU DD fCPU [MHz] 8 Functionality Functionality guaranteed notginu athraisn atereeda 6 i(nu nthleiss sarea otherwise 4 specified in the tables 2 of parametric data) 1 0 3.5 3.84.0 4.5 5.5 Supplyvoltage [V] Note: Some temperature ranges are only available with a specific package and memory size. Refer to Section14: Device configuration and ordering information. Warning: Do not connect 12 V to V before V is powered on, as this PP DD may damage the device. 144/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12.4 LVD/AVD characteristics 12.4.1 Operating conditions with LVD Subject to general operating conditions for T . A Table 87. O perating conditions with LVD Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit VD level = high in option byte 4.0(1) 4.2 4.5 V Reset release threshold (V rise) VD level = med. in option byte(2) 3.55(1) 3.75 4.0(1) IT+(LVD) DD VD level = low in option byte(2) 2.95(1) 3.15 3.35(1) V VD level = high in option byte 3.8 4.0 4.25(1) V Reset generation threshold (V fall) VD level = med. in option byte(2) 3.35(1) 3.55 3.75(1) IT-(LVD) DD VD level = low in option byte(2) 2.8(1) 3.0 3.15(1) V LVD voltage threshold hysteresis(1) V -V 150 200 250 mV hys(LVD) IT+(LVD) IT-(LVD) Flash devices 100ms/V Vt V rise time(1) 8/16 Kbyte ROM devices 6µs/V 20ms/V POR DD 32 Kbyte ROM devices ∝ ms/V t Filtered glitch delay on V (1) Not detected by the LVD 40 ns g(VDD) DD 1. Data based on characterization results, tested in production for ROM devices only. 2. If the medium or low thresholds are selected, the detection may occur outside the specified operating voltage range. 12.4.2 Auxiliary voltage detector (AVD) thresholds Subject to general operating conditions for T . A Table 88. A VD thresholds Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit VD level = high in option byte 4.4(1) 4.6 4.9 1 ⇒ 0 AVDF flag toggle threshold V VD level = med. in option byte 3.95(1) 4.15 4.4(1) IT+(AVD) (V rise) DD VD level = low in option byte 3.4(1) 3.6 3.8(1) V VD level = high in option byte 4.2 4.4 4.65(1) 0 ⇒ 1 AVDF flag toggle threshold V VD level = med. in option byte 3.75(1) 4.0 4.2(1) IT-(AVD) (V fall) DD VD level = low in option byte 3.2(1) 3.4 3.6(1) V AVD voltage threshold hysteresis V -V 200 hys(AVD) IT+(AVD) IT-(AVD) mV Voltage drop between AVD flag set and ΔV V -V 450 IT- LVD reset activated IT-(AVD) IT-(LVD) 1. Data based on characterization results, tested in production for ROM devices only. 145/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.5 Supply current characteristics The following current consumption specified for the ST7 functional operating modes over temperature range does not take into account the clock source current consumption. To obtain the total device consumption, the two current values must be added (except for Halt mode for which the clock is stopped). 12.5.1 ROM current consumption Table 89. R OM current consumption 32 Kbyte ROM 16/8 Kbyte devices ROM devices Symbol Parameter Conditions Unit Typ Max(1) Typ Max(1) f =2MHz, f =1MHz 0.55 0.87 0.46 0.69 OSC CPU f =4MHz, f =2MHz 1.10 1.75 0.93 1.4 Supply current in Run mode(2) OSC CPU mA f =8MHz, f =4MHz 2.20 3.5 1.9 2.7 OSC CPU f =16MHz, f =8MHz 4.38 7.0 3.7 5.5 OSC CPU f =2MHz, f =62.5kHz 53 87 30 60 OSC CPU f =4MHz, f =125kHz 100 175 70 120 Supply current in Slow mode(2) OSC CPU µA f =8MHz, f =250kHz 194 350 150 250 OSC CPU f =16MHz, f =500kHz 380 700 310 500 OSC CPU f =2MHz, f =1MHz 0.31 0.5 0.22 0.37 OSC CPU f =4MHz, f =2MHz 0.61 1.0 0.45 0.75 Supply current in Wait mode(2) OSC CPU mA f =8MHz, f =4MHz 1.22 2.0 0.91 1.5 OSC CPU I f =16MHz, f =8MHz 2.44 4.0 1.82 3 DD OSC CPU f =2MHz, f =62.5kHz 36 63 20 40 OSC CPU Supply current in Slow Wait f =4MHz, f =125kHz 69 125 40 90 OSC CPU mode(2) f =8MHz, f =250kHz 133 250 90 180 OSC CPU f =16MHz, f =500kHz 260 500 190 350 OSC CPU -40 °C<T <+85 °C <1 10 <1 10 Supply current in Halt mode(3) A µA -40 °C<T <+125 °C <1 50 <1 50 A f =2MHz 15 20 11 15 OSC Supply current in Active-halt f =4MHz 28 38 22 30 OSC mode(4) f =8MHz 55 75 43 60 OSC f =16MHz 107 200 85 150 OSC 1. Data based on characterization results, tested in production at V max. and f max. DD CPU 2. Measurements are done in the following conditions: - Program executed from RAM, CPU running with RAM access. The increase in consumption when executing from Flash is 50%. - All I/O pins in input mode with a static value at V or V (no load) DD SS - All peripherals in reset state - LVD disabled. - Clock input (OSC1) driven by external square wave - In Slow and Slow Wait modes, f is based on f divided by 32 CPU OSC To obtain the total current consumption of the device, add the clock source (Section12.6.3) and the peripheral power consumption (Section12.5.4). 3. All I/O pins in push-pull 0 mode (when applicable) with a static value at V or V (no load), LVD disabled. Data based on DD SS characterization results, tested in production at V max. and f max. DD CPU 4. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. All I/O pins in push-pull 0 mode (when applicable) with a static value at V or V (no load); clock input (OSC1) driven by external square wave, LVD disabled. To obtain the total DD SS current consumption of the device, add the clock source consumption (Section12.6.3). 146/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12.5.2 Flash current consumption T a ble 90. Flash current consumption 32 Kbyte 16/8 Kbyte Flash Flash Symbol Parameter Conditions Unit Typ Max(1) Typ Max(1) f =2MHz, f =1MHz 1.3 3.0 1 2.3 OSC CPU f =4MHz, f =2MHz 2.0 5.0 1.4 3.5 Supply current in Run mode(2) OSC CPU f =8MHz, f =4MHz 3.6 8.0 2.4 5.3 OSC CPU f =16MHz, f =8MHz 7.1 15.0 4.4 7.0 OSC CPU f =2MHz, f =62.5kHz 0.6 2.7 0.48 1 OSC CPU Supply current in Slow f =4MHz, f =125kHz 0.7 3.0 0.53 1.1 OSC CPU mA mode(2) f =8MHz, f =250kHz 0.8 3.6 0.63 1.2 OSC CPU f =16MHz, f =500kHz 1.1 4.0 0.80 1.4 OSC CPU f =2MHz, f =1MHz 0.8 3.0 0.6 1.8 OSC CPU f =4MHz, f =2MHz 1.2 4.0 0.9 2.2 Supply current in Wait mode(2) OSC CPU f =8MHz, f =4MHz 2.0 5.0 1.3 2.6 OSC CPU I f =16MHz, f =8MHz 3.5 7.0 2.3 3.6 DD OSC CPU f =2MHz, f =62.5kHz 580 1200 430 950 OSC CPU Supply current in Slow Wait f =4MHz, f =125kHz 650 1300 470 1000 OSC CPU mode(2) f =8MHz, f =250kHz 770 1800 530 1050 OSC CPU f =16MHz, f =500kHz 1050 2000 660 1200 OSC CPU -40°C<T <+85°C <1 10 <1 10 Supply current in Halt mode(3) A µA -40°C<T <+125°C 5 50 <1 50 A f =2MHz 365 475 315 425 OSC Supply current in Active-halt f =4MHz 380 500 330 450 OSC mode(4) f =8MHz 410 550 360 500 OSC f =16MHz 500 650 460 600 OSC 1. Data based on characterization results, tested in production at V max. and f max. DD CPU 2. Measurements are done in the following conditions: - Program executed from RAM, CPU running with RAM access. The increase in consumption when executing from Flash is 50%. - All I/O pins in input mode with a static value at V or V (no load) DD SS - All peripherals in reset state - LVD disabled - Clock input (OSC1) driven by external square wave - In Slow and Slow Wait modes, f is based on f divided by 32 CPU OSC - To obtain the total current consumption of the device, add the clock source (Section12.6.3) and the peripheral power consumption (Section12.5.4). 3. All I/O pins in push-pull 0 mode (when applicable) with a static value at V or V (no load), LVD disabled. Data based on DD SS characterization results, tested in production at V max. and f max. DD CPU 4. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. All I/O pins in push-pull 0 mode (when applicable) with a static value at V or V (no load); clock input (OSC1) driven by external square wave, LVD disabled. To obtain the total DD SS current consumption of the device, add the clock source consumption (Section12.6.3). 147/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.5.3 Supply and clock managers The previous current consumption specified for the ST7 functional operating modes over temperature range does not take into account the clock source current consumption. To obtain the total device consumption, the two current values must be added (except for Halt mode). T able 91. Oscillators, PLL and LVD current consumption Symbol Parameter Conditions Typ Max Unit I Supply current of internal RC oscillator 625 DD(RCINT) see Section12.6.3 I Supply current of resonator oscillator(1)(2) DD(RES) on page 150 µA I PLL supply current 360 DD(PLL) V = 5V DD I LVD supply current 150 300 DD(LVD) 1. Data based on characterization results done with the external components specified in Section12.6.3, not tested in production. 2. As the oscillator is based on a current source, the consumption does not depend on the voltage. 12.5.4 On-chip peripherals T a. ble 92. On-chip peripherals current consumption Symbol Parameter Conditions Typ Unit I 16-bit timer supply current(1) 50 DD(TIM) IDD(SPI) SPI supply current(2) TA = 25 °C, fCPU=4MHz, µA IDD(SCI) SCI supply current(3) VDD=5.0 V 400 I ADC supply current when converting(4) DD(ADC) 1. Data based on a differential I measurement between reset configuration (timer counter running at DD f /4) and timer counter stopped (only TIMD bit set). Data valid for one timer. CPU 2. Data based on a differential I measurement between reset configuration (SPI disabled) and a permanent DD SPI master communication at maximum speed (data sent equal to 55h). This measurement includes the pad toggling consumption. 3. Data based on a differential I measurement between SCI low power state (SCID=1) and a permanent DD SCI data transmit sequence. 4. Data based on a differential I measurement between reset configuration and continuous A/D DD conversions. 148/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12.6 Clock and timing characteristics Subject to general operating conditions for V , f , and T . DD CPU A 12.6.1 General timings T a ble 93. General timings Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ(1) Max Unit 2 3 12 t CPU t Instruction cycle time c(INST) f =8MHz 250 375 1500 ns CPU 10 22 t t Interrupt reaction time t = Δt + 10(2) CPU v(IT) v(IT) c(INST) f =8MHz 1.25 2.75 µs CPU 1. Data based on typical application software. 2. Time measured between interrupt event and interrupt vector fetch. Δt is the number of t cycles c(INST) CPU needed to finish the current instruction execution. 12.6.2 External clock source T able 94. External clock source Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit V OSC1 input pin high level voltage V -1 V OSC1H DD DD V V OSC1 input pin low level voltage V V +1 OSC1L SS SS tw(OSC1H) OSC1 high or low time(1) See Figure65. 5 t w(OSC1L) ns t r(OSC1) OSC1 rise or fall time(1) 15 t f(OSC1) I OSC1 input leakage current V <V < V ±1 µA lkg SS IN DD 1. Data based on design simulation and/or technology characteristics, not tested in production. Figure 65. Typical application with an external clock source 90% VOSC1H 10% VOSC1L tr(OSC1) tf(OSC1) tw(OSC1H) tw(OSC1L) OSC2 Not connected internally fOSC External clocksource Ilkg OSC1 ST72XXX 149/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.6.3 Crystal and ceramic resonator oscillators The ST7 internal clock can be supplied with four different crystal/ceramic resonator oscillators. All the information given in this paragraph are based on characterization results with specified typical external components. In the application, the resonator and the load capacitors have to be placed as close as possible to the oscillator pins in order to minimize output distortion and start-up stabilization time. Refer to the crystal/ceramic resonator manufacturer for more details (frequency, package, accuracy...). 8/16 Kbyte Flash and ROM devices T able 95. Crystal and ceramic resonator oscillators (8/16 Kbyte Flash and ROM devices) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit LP: low power oscillator 1 2 MP: medium power oscillator >2 4 f Oscillator frequency(1) MHz OSC MS: medium speed oscillator >4 8 HS: high speed oscillator >8 16 R Feedback resistor(2) 20 40 kΩ F Recommended load capacitance R =200 Ω LP oscillator 22 56 S C versus equivalent serial R =200 Ω MP oscillator 22 46 L1 S pF C resistance of the crystal or R =200 Ω MS oscillator 18 33 L2 S ceramic resonator (R )(3) R =100 Ω HS oscillator 15 33 S S V = 5V, V =V DD IN SS LP oscillator 80 150 i2 OSC2 driving current MP oscillator 160 250 µA MS oscillator 310 460 HS oscillator 610 910 1. The oscillator selection can be optimized in terms of supply current using an high quality resonator with small R value. Refer to crystal/ceramic resonator manufacturer for more details. S 2. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. The relatively low value of the RF resistor, offers a good protection against issues resulting from use in a humid environment, due to the induced leakage and the bias condition change. However, it is recommended to take this point into account if the microcontroller is used in tough humidity conditions. 3. For C and C it is recommended to use high-quality ceramic capacitors in the 5 pF to 25 pF range (typ.) L1 L2 designed for high-frequency applications and selected to match the requirements of the crystal or resonator. C and C , are usually the same size. The crystal manufacturer typically specifies a load L1 L2 capacitance which is the series combination of C and C . PCB and MCU pin capacitance must be L1 L2 included when sizing C and C (10 pF can be used as a rough estimate of the combined pin and board L1 L2 capacitance). 150/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics Figure 66. Typical application with a crystal or ceramic resonator (8/16Kbyte Flash and ROM devices) Whenresonatorwith integratedcapacitors i2 fOSC CL1 OSC1 Resonator RF CL2 OSC2 ST72XXX 32 Kbyte Flash and ROM devices T a ble 96. Crystal and ceramic resonator oscillators (32Kbyte Flash and ROM devices) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit f Oscillator frequency(1) 1 16 MHz OSC R Feedback resistor(2) 20 40 kΩ F Recommended load f = 1 to 2 MHz 20 60 OSC C capacitance versus equivalent f = 2 to 4 MHz 20 50 L1 OSC pF C serial resistance of the crystal or f = 4 to 8 MHz 15 35 L2 OSC ceramic resonator (R )(3) f = 8 to 16 MHz 15 35 S OSC V = 5V, V =V DD IN SS LP oscillator 80 150 i2 OSC2 driving current MP oscillator 160 250 µA MS oscillator 310 460 HS oscillator 610 910 1. The oscillator selection can be optimized in terms of supply current using an high quality resonator with small RS value. Refer to crystal/ceramic resonator manufacturer for more details. 2. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. The relatively low value of the RF resistor, offers a good protection against issues resulting from use in a humid environment, due to the induced leakage and the bias condition change. However, it is recommended to take this point into account if the microcontroller is used in tough humidity conditions. 3. For C and C it is recommended to use high-quality ceramic capacitors in the 5-pF to 25-pF range (typ.) L1 L2 designed for high-frequency applications and selected to match the requirements of the crystal or resonator. C and C , are usually the same size. The crystal manufacturer typically specifies a load L1 L2 capacitance which is the series combination of C and C . PCB and MCU pin capacitance must be L1 L2 included when sizing C and C (10 pF can be used as a rough estimate of the combined pin and board L1 L2 capacitance). 151/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx Figure 67. Typical application with a crystal or ceramic resonator (32Kbyte Flash and ROM devices) Whenresonatorwith integratedcapacitors fOSC Power down CL1 OSC1 logic Linear Feedback amplifier loop Resonator VDD/2 i2 RF ref CL2 OSC2 ST72XXX T able 97. OSCRANGE selection for typical resonators Typical ceramic resonators(1) f Supplier OSC (MHz) Recommended OSCRANGE Reference option bit configuration 2 CSTCC2M00G56A-R0 MP mode(2) 4 CSTCR4M00G55B-R0 MS mode Murata 8 CSTCE8M00G52A-R0 HS mode 16 CSTCE16M0V51A-R0 HS mode 1. Resonator characteristics given by the ceramic resonator manufacturer. 2. LP mode is not recommended for 2 MHz resonator because the peak to peak amplitude is too small (>0.8 V). For more information on these resonators, please consult www.murata.com. 12.6.4 RC oscillators T a ble 98. RC oscillators Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit Internal RC oscillator frequency T =25 °C, f A 2 3.5 5.6 MHz OSC (RCINT) (see Figure68) V =5 V DD Figure 68. Typical f vs T OSC(RCINT) A 4 z)3.8 Vdd = 5V H M Vdd = 5.5V (3.6 T) N CI 3.4 R C( OS 3.2 f 3 -45 0 25 70 130 T(°C) A 152/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics Note: To reduce disturbance to the RC oscillator, it is recommended to place decoupling capacitors between V and V as shown in Figure87 on page170. DD SS 12.6.5 PLL characteristics T a ble 99. PLL characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit f PLL input frequency range 2 4 MHz OSC Δ f /f Instantaneous PLL jitter(1) f = 4 MHz 0.7 2 % CPU CPU OSC 1. Data characterized but not tested The user must take the PLL jitter into account in the application (for example in serial communication or sampling of high frequency signals). The PLL jitter is a periodic effect, which is integrated over several CPU cycles. Therefore the longer the period of the application signal, the less it will be impacted by the PLL jitter. Figure69 shows the PLL jitter integrated on application signals in the range 125kHz to 2MHz. At frequencies of less than 125kHz, the jitter is negligible. Figure 69. Integrated PLL jitter vs signal frequency(1) +/-Jitter (%) 1.2 1 Max Typ 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 4 MHz 2 MHz 1 MHz 500 kHz 250 kHz 125 kHz Application Frequency 1. Measurement conditions: f = 8MHz CPU 12.7 Memory characteristics 12.7.1 RAM and hardware registers T a ble 100. RAM and hardware registers Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit V Data retention mode(1) Halt mode (or reset) 1.6 V RM 1. Minimum V supply voltage without losing data stored in RAM (in Halt mode or under reset) or in DD hardware registers (only in Halt mode). Not tested in production. 153/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.7.2 Flash memory T a ble 101. Dual voltage HDFlash memory Symbol Parameter Conditions Min(1) Typ Max(1) Unit Read mode 0 8 f Operating frequency MHz CPU Write/Erase mode 1 8 V Programming voltage(2) 4.5 V < V < 5.5 V 11.4 12.6 V PP DD I Supply current(3) Write/Erase <10 µA DD Read (V =12 V) 200 µA I V current(3) PP PP PP Write/Erase 30 mA t Internal V stabilization time 10 µs VPP PP T = 85 °C 40 A t Data retention T = 105 °C 15 years RET A T = 125 °C 7 A T =85 °C 100 cycles A N Write erase cycles RW T =55 °C 1000 cycles A T Programming or erasing PROG -40 25 85 °C T temperature range ERASE 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. 2. V must be applied only during the programming or erasing operation and not permanently for reliability PP reasons. 3. Data based on simulation results, not tested in production. 154/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12.8 EMC characteristics Susceptibility tests are performed on a sample basis during product characterization. 12.8.1 Functional electromagnetic susceptibility (EMS) Based on a simple running application on the product (toggling two LEDs through I/O ports), the product is stressed by two electromagnetic events until a failure occurs (indicated by the LEDs). ● ESD: Electrostatic discharge (positive and negative) is applied on all pins of the device until a functional disturbance occurs. This test conforms with the IEC 1000-4-2 standard. ● FTB: A burst of fast transient voltage (positive and negative) is applied to V and V DD SS through a 100 pF capacitor, until a functional disturbance occurs. This test conforms with the IEC 1000-4-4 standard. A device reset allows normal operations to be resumed. The test results given in Table102 on page156 are based on the EMS levels and classes defined in application note AN1709. Designing hardened software to avoid noise problems EMC characterization and optimization are performed at component level with a typical application environment and simplified MCU software. It should be noted that good EMC performance is highly dependent on the user application and the software in particular. Therefore it is recommended that the user applies EMC software optimization and prequalification tests in relation with the EMC level requested for his application. Software recommendations The software flowchart must include the management of runaway conditions such as: ● corrupted program counter ● unexpected reset ● critical data corruption (control registers...) Prequalification trials Most of the common failures (unexpected reset and program counter corruption) can be reproduced by manually forcing a low state on the reset pin or the oscillator pins for 1 second. To complete these trials, ESD stress can be applied directly on the device, over the range of specification values. When unexpected behavior is detected, the software can be hardened to prevent unrecoverable errors occurring (see application note AN1015). 155/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx Table 102. E MS test results Symbol Parameter Conditions Level/class 32Kbyte Flash or ROM device: V = 5 V, T = +25 °C, f = 8MHz 3B DD A OSC conforms to IEC 1000-4-2 8 or 16Kbyte ROM device: Voltage limits to be applied on any I/O pin to V V = 5 V, T = +25°C, f = 8MHz 4A FESD induce a functional disturbance DD A OSC conforms to IEC 1000-4-2 8 or 16Kbyte Flash device: V = 5 V, T = +25 °C, f = 8MHz 4B DD A OSC conforms to IEC 1000-4-2 Fast transient voltage burst limits to be V = 5 V, T = +25 °C, f = 8MHz V applied through 100 pF on V and V DD A OSC 4A FFTB DD DD conforms to IEC 1000-4-4 pins to induce a functional disturbance 12.8.2 Electromagnetic interference (EMI) Based on a simple application running on the product (toggling two LEDs through the I/O ports), the product is monitored in terms of emission. This emission test is in line with the norm SAE J 1752/3 which specifies the board and the loading of each pin. Table 103. E MI emissions Max vs [f /f ] Monitored OSC CPU Symbol Parameter Conditions Device/package(1) Unit frequency band 8/4MHz 16/8MHz 0.1MHz to 30MHz 12 18 8/16Kbyte Flash 30MHz to 130MHz 19 25 dBµV LQFP32 and LQFP44 130MHz to 1GHz 15 22 SAE EMI Level 3 3.5 - 0.1MHz to 30MHz 13 14 32Kbyte Flash 30MHz to 130MHz 20 25 dBµV LQFP32 and LQFP44 130MHz to 1GHz 16 21 V = 5 V DD T =+25 °C SAE EMI Level 3.0 3.5 - S Peak level(2) A EMI conforming to 0.1MHz to 30MHz 12 15 SAE J 1752/3 30MHz to 130MHz 23 26 dBµV 8/16Kbyte ROM LQFP32 and LQFP44 130MHz to 1GHz 15 20 SAE EMI Level 3.0 3.5 - 0.1MHz to 30MHz 17 21 32Kbyte ROM 30MHz to 130MHz 24 30 dBµV LQFP32 and LQFP44 130MHz to 1GHz 18 23 SAE EMI Level 3.0 3.5 - 1. Refer to application note AN1709 for data on other package types. 2. Not tested in production. 156/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12.8.3 Absolute maximum ratings (electrical sensitivity) Based on two different tests (ESD and LU) using specific measurement methods, the product is stressed in order to determine its performance in terms of electrical sensitivity. For more details, refer to the application note AN1181. Electrostatic discharge (ESD) Electrostatic discharges (a positive then a negative pulse separated by 1 second) are applied to the pins of each sample according to each pin combination. The sample size depends on the number of supply pins in the device (3 parts*(n+1) supply pin). Two models can be simulated: human body model and machine model. This test conforms to the JESD22-A114A/A115A standard. T a ble 104. Absolute maximum ratings Symbol Ratings Conditions Maximum value(1) Unit Electrostatic discharge voltage V 2000 ESD(HBM) (human body model) T =+25 °C V A Electrostatic discharge voltage V 750 ESD(CDM) (charged device model) 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. Static latch-up ● LU: two complementary static tests are required on 6 parts to assess the latch-up performance. A supply overvoltage (applied to each power supply pin) and a current injection (applied to each input, output and configurable I/O pin) are performed on each sample. This test conforms to the EIA/JESD 78 IC latch-up standard. T a ble 105. Electrical sensitivities Test Symbol Parameter Conditions Class specification T = +25 °C A LU Static latch-up class T = +85 °C JESD 78 II level A A T = +125 °C A 157/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.9 I/O port pin characteristics 12.9.1 General characteristics Subject to general operating conditions for V , f , and T unless otherwise specified. DD OSC A Table 106. G eneral characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit Input low level voltage V 0.3xV IL (standard voltage devices)(1) DD V V Input high level voltage(1) 0.7xV IH DD V Schmitt trigger voltage hysteresis(2) 0.7 hys Injected current on I/O pins other than pin PB0(4) ±4 Injected current on ROM and 32Kbyte I (3) V = 5 V mA INJ(PIN) Flash devices pin PB0 DD Injected current on 8/16Kbyte Flash 0 +4 devices pin PB0 Total injected current ΣI (3) V = 5 V ±25 mA INJ(PIN) (sum of all I/O and control pins) DD Ilkg Input leakage current VSS<VIN<VDD ±1 µA Static current consumption induced by I Floating input mode(5)(6) 200 S each floating input pin R Weak pull-up equivalent resistor(7) V = V V = 5 V 50 120 250 kΩ PU IN SS, DD C I/O pin capacitance 5 pF IO tf(IO)out Output high to low level fall time(1) CL = 50 pF 25 ns t Output low to high level rise time(1) between 10% and 90% 25 r(IO)out t External interrupt pulse time(8) 1 t w(IT)in CPU 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. 2. Hysteresis voltage between Schmitt trigger switching levels. Based on characterization results, not tested. 3. When the current limitation is not possible, the V maximum must be respected, otherwise refer to the I IN INJ(PIN) specification. A positive injection is induced by V >V while a negative injection is induced by V <V . Refer to IN DD IN SS Section12.2.2 on page 143 for more details. 4. No negative current injection allowed on 8/16Kbyte Flash devices 5. Static peak current value taken at a fixed V value, based on design simulation and technology characteristics, not tested IN in production. This value depends on V and temperature values. DD 6. The Schmitt trigger that is connected to every I/O port is disabled for analog inputs only when ADON bit is ON and the particular ADC channel is selected (with port configured in input floating mode). When the ADON bit is OFF, static current consumption may result. This can be avoided by keeping the input voltage of this pin close to V or V . DD SS 7. The R pull-up equivalent resistor is based on a resistive transistor (corresponding I current characteristics described in PU PU Figure71). 8. To generate an external interrupt, a minimum pulse width has to be applied on an I/O port pin configured as an external interrupt source. 158/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics Figure 70. Unused I/O pins configured as input(1) VDD ST7XXX 10 kΩ UnusedI/Oport 10 kΩ UnusedI/Oport ST7XXX 1. I/O can be left unconnected if it is configured as output (0 or 1) by the software. This has the advantage of greater EMC robustness and lower cost. Figure 71. Typical I vs. V with V = V PU DD IN SS 90 80 Ta=140°C Ta=95°C 70 Ta=25°C 60 Ta=-45°C Ipu(uA)4500 30 20 10 0 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 6 Vdd(V) 12.9.2 Output driving current Subject to general operating conditions for V , f , and T unless otherwise specified. DD CPU A Table 107. O utput driving current Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit Output low level voltage for a standard I/O I = +5 mA 1.2 IO pin when 8 pins are sunk at same time (see Figure72) IIO = +2 mA 0.5 V (1) I = +20 mA OL IO Output low level voltage for a high sink I/O T <85 °C 1.3 A pin when 4 pins are sunk at same time T >85 °C 1.5 (see Figure73 and Figure75) VDD=5V A V I = +8 mA 0.6 IO I = -5 mA, IO Output high level voltage for an I/O pin T <85 °C V -1.4 VOH(2) when 4 pins are sourced at same time TAA>85 °C VDDDD-1.6 (see Figure74 and Figure77) I = -2 mA V -0.7 IO DD 1. The I current sunk must always respect the absolute maximum rating specified in Section12.2.2 and the sum of I (I/O IO IO ports and control pins) must not exceed I . VSS 2. The I current sourced must always respect the absolute maximum rating specified in Section12.2.2 and the sum of I IO IO (I/O ports and control pins) must not exceed I . True open drain I/O pins do not have V . VDD OH 159/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx Figure 72. Typical V at V =5 V (standard ports) OL DD 1.4 1.2 1 V 5 = dd 0.8 V V) at 0.6 ol ( V 0.4 Ta=140°C " Ta=95°C Ta=25°C 0.2 Ta=-45°C 0 0 0.5005 01.001 01.5015 IIOI i(om(AA)) Figure 73. Typical V at V = 5 V (high-sink ports) OL DD 1 0.9 0.8 V 0.7 5 d= 0.6 d at V 0.5 V) 0.4 ol( Ta= 140°C V 0.3 Ta=95°C 0.2 Ta=25°C 0.1 Ta=-45°C 0 0 0.01 123000 0.02 0.03 IIO (mIiAo)(A) Figure 74. Typical V at V =5 V OH DD 5.5 5 V 5 4.5 = d d at V 4 V) h ( 3.5 o V Vdd=5V 140°C min dd- 3 Vdd=5v 95°C min V Vdd=5v 25°C min 2.5 Vdd=5v -45°C min 2 -10 -8 -6 -4 -2 0 -0.01 -0.008 -0.006 -0.004 -0.002 0 IIO I(imo A(A)) 160/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics Figure 75. Typical V vs. V (standard ports) OL DD 1 0.45 0.9 Ta=-45°C Ta=-45°C Ta=25°C 0.4 Ta=25°C A 00..78 TTaa==9154°0C°C 0.35 TTaa==9154°0C°C =5m 0.6 2mA 0.3 Vol(V) at Iio 000...345 Vol(V) at Iio= 00..012.552 0.2 0.1 0.1 0.05 0 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 6 0 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 6 Vdd(V) Vdd(V) Figure 76. Typical V vs. V (high-sink ports) OL DD 0.6 1.6 1.4 Ta= 140°C 0.5 Ta=95°C 1.2 Ta=25°C 0.4 Ta=-45°C Vol(V) at Iio=8mA 0.3 Vol(V) at Iio=20mA 00..681 0.2 Ta= 140°C Ta=95°C 0.4 0.1 Ta=25°C 0.2 Ta=-45°C 0 0 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 6 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 6 Vdd(V) Vdd(V) Figure 77. Typical V vs. V OH DD 5.5 6 Ta=-45°C 5 5 Ta=25°C Voh(V) at Iio=-2mA34..545 Ta=-45°C Voh(V) at Iio=-5mA34 TTaa==9154°0C°C Vdd- 3 Ta=25°C Vdd-2 Ta=95°C 2.5 1 Ta=140°C 2 0 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 6 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 6 Vdd(V) Vdd(V) 161/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.10 Control pin characteristics 12.10.1 Asynchronous RESET pin Subject to general operating conditions for V , f , and T unless otherwise specified. DD CPU A Table 108. A synchronous RESET pin Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit V Input low level voltage(1) 0.3xV V IL DD V Input high level voltage(1) 0.7xV IH DD V Schmitt trigger voltage hysteresis(2) 2.5 hys V Output low level voltage(3) V = 5 V, I = +2 mA 0.2 0.5 V OL DD IO I Driving current on RESET pin 2 mA IO R Weak pull-up equivalent resistor V = 5V 20 30 120 kΩ ON DD t Generated reset pulse duration Internal reset sources 20 30 42(4) µs w(RSTL)out t External reset pulse hold time(5) 2.5 µs h(RSTL)in t Filtered glitch duration(6) 200 ns g(RSTL)in 1. Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. 2. Hysteresis voltage between Schmitt trigger switching levels. 3. The I current sunk must always respect the absolute maximum rating specified in Section12.2.2 and the sum of I (I/O IO IO ports and control pins) must not exceed I . VSS 4. Data guaranteed by design, not tested in production. 5. To guarantee the reset of the device, a minimum pulse has to be applied to the RESET pin. All short pulses applied on the RESET pin with a duration below t can be ignored. h(RSTL)in 6. The reset network (the resistor and two capacitors) protects the device against parasitic resets, especially in noisy environments. 162/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics RESET pin protection when LVD is enabled When the LVD is enabled, it is recommended to protect the RESET pin as shown in Figure78 and follow these guidelines: 1. The reset network protects the device against parasitic resets. 2. The output of the external reset circuit must have an open-drain output to drive the ST7 reset pad. Otherwise the device can be damaged when the ST7 generates an internal reset (LVD or watchdog). 3. Whatever the reset source is (internal or external), the user must ensure that the level on the RESET pin can go below the V max. level specified in Section12.10.1. IL Otherwise the reset will not be taken into account internally. 4. Because the reset circuit is designed to allow the internal RESET to be output in the RESET pin, the user must ensure that the current sunk on the RESET pin (by an external pull-up for example) is less than the absolute maximum value specified for I in Section12.2.2 on page 143. INJ(RESET) 5. When the LVD is enabled, it is mandatory not to connect a pull-up resistor. A 10nF pull- down capacitor is recommended to filter noise on the reset line. 6. In case a capacitive power supply is used, it is recommended to connect a 1M ohm pull-down resistor to the RESET pin to discharge any residual voltage induced by this capacitive power supply (this will add 5 µA to the power consumption of the MCU). Tips when using the LVD: ● Check that all recommendations related to reset circuit have been applied (see section above) ● Check that the power supply is properly decoupled (100 nF + 10 µF close to the MCU). Refer to AN1709. If this cannot be done, it is recommended to put a 100 nF + 1 M Ohm pull-down on the RESET pin. ● The capacitors connected on the RESET pin and also the power supply are key to avoiding any start-up marginality. In most cases, steps 1 and 2 above are sufficient for a robust solution. Otherwise: Replace 10 nF pull-down on the RESET pin with a 5 µF to 20 µF capacitor. Figure 78. RESET pin protection when LVD is enabled VDD ST72XXX Recommended Optional RON (note 6) External Filter Internal reset reset 0.01 µF 1 MΩ Pulse Watchdog generator LVDreset 163/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx RESET pin protection when LVD is disabled When the LVD is disabled, it is recommended to protect the RESET pin as shown in Figure79 and follow these guidelines: 1. The reset network protects the device against parasitic resets. 2. The output of the external reset circuit must have an open-drain output to drive the ST7 reset pad. Otherwise the device can be damaged when the ST7 generates an internal reset (LVD or watchdog). 3. Whatever the reset source is (internal or external), the user must ensure that the level on the RESET pin can go below the V max. level specified in Section12.10.1. IL Otherwise the reset will not be taken into account internally. 4. Because the reset circuit is designed to allow the internal RESET to be output in the RESET pin, the user must ensure that the current sunk on the RESET pin (by an external pull-up for example) is less than the absolute maximum value specified for I in Section12.2.2 on page 143. INJ(RESET) Figure 79. RESET pin protection when LVD is disabled VDD ST72XXX VDD User 4.7kΩ RON external reset Filter Internal circuit reset 0.01µF Pulse Watchdog generator Required 164/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12.10.2 ICCSEL/V pin PP Subject to general operating conditions for V , f , and T unless otherwise specified. DD CPU A T able 109. ICCSEL/V pin PP Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit Flash versions V 0.2 V Input low level voltage(1) SS IL ROM versions V 0.3xV SS DD V Flash versions V -0.1 12.6 V Input high level voltage(1) DD IH ROM versions 0.7xV V DD DD I Input leakage current V = V ±1 µA lkg IN SS 1. Data based on design simulation and/or technology characteristics, not tested in production. Figure 80. Two typical applications with ICCSEL/V pin(1) PP ICCSEL/VPP Programming VPP tool 10kΩ ST72XXX ST72XXX 1. When ICC mode is not required by the application ICCSEL/V pin must be tied to V . PP SS 12.11 Timer peripheral characteristics Subject to general operating conditions for V , f , and T unless otherwise specified. DD OSC A Refer to I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output alternate function characteristics (output compare, input capture, external clock, PWM output...). Data based on design simulation and/or characterization results, not tested in production. 12.11.1 16-bit timer T a ble 110. 16-bit timer Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit t Input capture pulse time 1 t w(ICAP)in CPU 2 t CPU t PWM resolution time res(PWM) f =8MHz 250 ns CPU f Timer external clock frequency EXT 0 f /4 MHz CPU f PWM repetition rate PWM Res PWM resolution 16 bit PWM 165/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.12 Communication interface characteristics 12.12.1 Serial peripheral interface (SPI) The following characteristics are ubject to general operating conditions for V , f , and T DD CPU A unless otherwise specified. The data is based on design simulation and/or characterization results, not tested in production. When no communication is on-going the data output line of the SPI (MOSI in master mode, MISO in slave mode) has its alternate function capability released. In this case, the pin status depends on the I/O port configuration. Refer to the I/O port characteristics for more details on the input/output alternate function characteristics (SS, SCK, MOSI, MISO). Table 111. S PI characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Max Unit fSCK SPI clock frequency Master fCPU = 8MHz fCPU/128=0.0625 fCPU/4=2 MHz 1/tc(SCK) Slave fCPU = 8MHz 0 fCPU/2=4 t r(SCK) SPI clock rise and fall time see I/O port pin description t f(SCK) t (1) SS setup time(2) Slave t +50 su(SS) CPU t (1) SS hold time Slave 120 h(SS) t (1) Master 100 w(SCKH) SCK high and low time t (1) Slave 90 w(SCKL) t (1) Master 100 su(MI) Data input setup time t (1) Slave 100 su(SI) t (1) Master 100 h(MI) Data input hold time t (1) Slave 100 ns h(SI) t (1) Data output access time Slave 0 120 a(SO) t (1) Data output disable time Slave 240 dis(SO) t (1) Data output valid time 120 v(SO) Slave (after enable edge) t (1) Data output hold time 0 h(SO) t (1) Data output valid time 120 v(MO) Master (after enable edge) t (1) Data output hold time 0 h(MO) 1. Data based on design simulation and/or characterization results, not tested in production. 2. Depends on f . For example, if f = 8 MHz, then t = 1 / f = 125 ns and t = 175 ns. CPU CPU CPU CPU su(SS) 166/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics Figure 81. SPI slave timing diagram with CPHA=0(1) SSINPUT tsu(SS) tc(SCK) th(SS) T CPHA=0 U CPOL=0 P N I K CPHA=0 SC CPOL=1 ta(SO) ttww((SSCCKKHL)) tv(SO) th(SO) ttrf((SSCCKK)) tdis(SO) MISOOUTPUTSeenote2 MSBOUT Bit 6OUT LSBOUT nSoetee2 tsu(SI) th(SI) MOSIINPUT MSBIN Bit 1IN LSBIN 1. Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.3xV and 0.7xV . DD DD 2. When no communication is on-going the data output line of the SPI (MOSI in master mode, MISO in slave mode) has its alternate function capability released. In this case, the pin status depends on the I/O port configuration. Figure 82. SPI slave timing diagram with CPHA=1(1) SSINPUT tsu(SS) tc(SCK) th(SS) T CPHA=1 PU CPOL=0 N KI CPHA=1 C CPOL=1 S ta(SO) ttww((SSCCKKHL)) tv(SO) th(SO) ttrf((SSCCKK)) tdis(SO) MISOOUTPUT sneoete2 HZ MSBOUT Bit 6OUT LSBOUT sneoete2 tsu(SI) th(SI) MOSIINPUT MSBIN Bit 1IN LSBIN 1. Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.3xV and 0.7xV . DD DD 2. When no communication is on-going the data output line of the SPI (MOSI in master mode, MISO in slave mode) has its alternate function capability released. In this case, the pin status depends on the I/O port configuration. 167/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx Figure 83. SPI master timing diagram(1) SSINPUT tc(SCK) CPHA=0 CPOL=0 T CPHA=0 PU CPOL=1 N I K C CPHA=1 S CPOL=0 CPHA=1 CPOL=1 ttww((SSCCKKLH)) ttrf((SSCCKK)) tsu(MI) th(MI) MISOINPUT MSBIN BIT6IN LSBIN tv(MO) th(MO) MOSIOUTPUT Seenote2 MSBOUT BIT6OUT LSBOUT Seenote2 1. Measurement points are done at CMOS levels: 0.3xV and 0.7xV . DD DD 2. When no communication is on-going the data output line of the SPI (MOSI in master mode, MISO in slave mode) has its alternate function capability released. In this case, the pin status depends on the I/O port configuration. 12.13 10-bit ADC characteristics Subject to general operating conditions for V , f , and T unless otherwise specified. DD CPU A T able 112. 10-bit ADC characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit f ADC clock frequency 0.4 2 MHz ADC V Analog reference voltage 0.7*V < V < V 3.8 V AREF DD AREF DD DD V V Conversion voltage range(1) V V AIN SSA AREF Input leakage current for analog -40 °C < TA < + 85 °C ±250 nA I lkg input(2) Other T ranges ±1 µA A R External input impedance See kΩ AIN figures C External capacitor on analog input pF AIN 84 and f Variation freq. of analog input signal 85 Hz AIN C Internal sample and hold capacitor 12 pF ADC 168/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics Table 112. 10-bit ADC characteristics (continued) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min Typ Max Unit Conversion time (Sample + Hold) f =8MHz, Speed=0, 7.5 µs CPU tADC fADC=2MHz No. of sample capacitor loading cycles 4 1/f No. of Hold conversion cycles 11 ADC 1. Any added external serial resistor will downgrade the ADC accuracy (especially for resistance greater than 10kΩ). Data based on characterization results, not tested in production. 2. Injecting negative current on adjacent pins may result in increased leakage currents. Software filtering of the converted analog value is recommended. Figure 84. R max. vs f with C =0 pF(1) AIN ADC AIN 45 40 35 2 MHz R (Kohm)AIN223050 1 MHz Max. 15 10 5 0 0 10 30 70 CPARASITIC (pF) 1. C represents the capacitance of the PCB (dependent on soldering and PCB layout quality) plus PARASITIC the pad capacitance (3 pF). A high C value will downgrade conversion accuracy. To remedy this, PARASITIC f should be reduced. ADC Figure 85. Recommended C and R values(1) AIN AIN 1000 Cain 10 nF 100 Cain 22 nF m) Cain 47 nF R (KohAIN 10 Max. 1 0.1 0.01 0.1 1 10 fAIN(KHz) 1. This graph shows that, depending on the input signal variation (f ), C can be increased for AIN AIN stabilization time and decreased to allow the use of a larger serial resistor (R . AIN) Figure 86. Typical A/D converter application VDD ST72XXX VT RAIN AINx 0.6 V 2 kΩ (max) 10-bit A/D VAIN conversion CAIN V0.T6 V Ilkg CADC 12 pF 169/193

Electrical characteristics ST72324Bxx 12.13.1 Analog power supply and reference pins Depending on the MCU pin count, the package may feature separate V and V AREF SSA analog power supply pins. These pins supply power to the A/D converter cell and function as the high and low reference voltages for the conversion. In some packages, V and AREF V pins are not available (refer to Section2 on page 15). In this case the analog supply SSA and reference pads are internally bonded to the V and V pins. DD SS Separation of the digital and analog power pins allow board designers to improve A/D performance. Conversion accuracy can be impacted by voltage drops and noise in the event of heavily loaded or badly decoupled power supply lines (see Section12.13.2: General PCB design guidelines). 12.13.2 General PCB design guidelines To obtain best results, some general design and layout rules should be followed when designing the application PCB to shield the noise-sensitive, analog physical interface from noise-generating CMOS logic signals. ● Use separate digital and analog planes. The analog ground plane should be connected to the digital ground plane via a single point on the PCB. ● Filter power to the analog power planes. It is recommended to connect capacitors, with good high frequency characteristics, between the power and ground lines,placing 0.1µF and optionally, if needed 10 pF capacitors as close as possible to the ST7 power supply pins and a 1 to 10 µF capacitor close to the power source (see Figure87). ● The analog and digital power supplies should be connected in a star network. Do not use a resistor, as V isused as a reference voltage by the A/D converter andany AREF resistance would cause a voltage drop and a loss of accuracy. ● Properly place components and route the signal traces on the PCB to shield the analog inputs. Analog signals paths should run over the analog ground plane and be as short as possible. Isolate analog signals from digital signals that may switch while the analog inputs are being sampled by the A/D converter. Do not toggle digital outputs on the same I/O port as the A/D input being converted. Figure 87. Power supply filtering ST72XXX 1 to 10 µF 0.1 µF VSS ST7 digitalnoise filtering VDD VDD Power supply 0.1 µF source VAREF External noise filtering VSSA 170/193

ST72324Bxx Electrical characteristics 12.13.3 ADC accuracy Table 113. A DC accuracy Max(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Typ ROM and Unit 32Kbyte 8/16Kbyte Flash Flash |E | Total unadjusted error(2) 3 4 6 T |EO| Offset error(2) (2)V 2 3 5 |E | Gain error(2) 5 CPU in run mode @ f 2 MHz 0.5 3 4.5 LSB G = ADC |ED| Differential linearity error(2) DD 2 V 1 2 |E | Integral linearity error(2) 3 L 1. Data based on characterization results, monitored in production to guarantee 99.73% within ± max value from -40°C to 125 °C (± 3σ distribution limits). 2. ADC accuracy vs. negative injection current: Injecting negative current may reduce the accuracy of the conversion being performed on another analog input. Any positive injection current within the limits specified for I and ΣI in INJ(PIN) INJ(PIN) Section12.9 does not affect the ADC accuracy. Figure 88. ADC accuracy characteristics Digital result ADCDR E (1) Example of an actual transfer curve. G 1023 (2) The ideal transfer curve. (3) End point correlation line. 1022 VAREF–VSSA 1LSB =-------------------------------------------- 1021 IDEAL 1024 ET = Total Unadjusted Error: maximum deviation between the actual and the ideal (2) transfer curves. E EO = Offset Error: deviation between the first T (3) actual transition and the first ideal one. 7 EG = Gain Error: deviation between the last (1) ideal transition and the last actual one. 6 ED = Differential Linearity Error: maximum 5 deviation between actual steps and the ideal E E one. O L 4 EL = Integral Linearity Error: maximum deviation between any actual transition and the 3 E end point correlation line. D 2 1LSB 1 IDEAL 0 Vin (LSBIDEAL) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1021 1023 VSSA VAREF 171/193

Package characteristics ST72324Bxx 13 Package characteristics 13.1 ECOPACK In order to meet environmental requirements, ST offers these devices in different grades of ECOPACK® packages, depending on their level of environmental compliance. ECOPACK® specifications, grade definitions and product status are available at: www.st.com. ECOPACK® is an ST trademark. 13.2 Package mechanical data 13.2.1 LQFP44 package mechanical data Figure 89. 44-pin low profile quad flat package outline D A D1 A2 A1 b e E1 E L1 c L h T able 114. 44-pin low profile quad flat package mechanical data mm inches (1) Dim. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 1.60 0.0630 A1 0.05 0.15 0.0020 0.0059 A2 1.35 1.40 1.45 0.0531 0.0551 0.0571 b 0.30 0.37 0.45 0.0118 0.0146 0.0177 C 0.09 0.20 0.0035 0.0079 D 12.00 0.4724 D1 10.00 0.3937 E 12.00 0.4724 172/193

ST72324Bxx Package characteristics Table 114. 44-pin low profile quad flat package mechanical data (continued) mm inches (1) Dim. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max E1 10.00 0.3937 e 0.80 0.0315 θ 0° 3.5° 7° 0° 3.5° 7° L 0.45 0.60 0.75 0.0177 0.0236 0.0295 L1 1.00 0.0394 Number of pins N 44 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. 13.2.2 SDIP42 package mechanical data Figure 90. 42-pin plastic dual in-line package, shrink 600-mil width E A2 A A1 L c E1 b2 b e eA eB D E 0.015 GAGE PLANE eC eB T able 115. 42-pin dual in line package mechanical data mm inches (1) Dim. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 5.08 0.2000 A1 0.51 0.0201 A2 3.05 3.81 4.57 0.1201 0.1500 0.1799 b 0.38 0.46 0.56 0.0150 0.0181 0.0220 b2 0.89 1.02 1.14 0.0350 0.0402 0.0449 c 0.23 0.25 0.38 0.0091 0.0098 0.0150 D 36.58 36.83 37.08 1.4402 1.4500 1.4598 173/193

Package characteristics ST72324Bxx Table 115. 42-pin dual in line package mechanical data mm inches (1) Dim. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max E 15.24 16.00 0.6000 0.6299 E1 12.70 13.72 14.48 0.5000 0.5402 0.5701 e 1.78 0.0701 eA 15.24 0.6000 eB 18.54 0.7299 eC 1.52 0.0598 L 2.54 3.30 3.56 0.1000 0.1299 0.1402 Number of pins N 42 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. 13.2.3 LQFP32 package mechanical data Figure 91. 32-pin low profile quad flat package outline D A D1 A2 A1 e E1E b c L1 L h T able 116. 32-pin low profile quad flat package mechanical data mm inches (1) Dim. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 1.60 0.0630 A1 0.05 0.15 0.0020 0.0059 A2 1.35 1.40 1.45 0.0531 0.0551 0.0571 b 0.30 0.37 0.45 0.0118 0.0146 0.0177 C 0.09 0.20 0.0035 0.0079 D 9.00 0.3543 D1 7.00 0.2756 174/193

ST72324Bxx Package characteristics Table 116. 32-pin low profile quad flat package mechanical data (continued) mm inches (1) Dim. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max E 9.00 0.3543 E1 7.00 0.2756 e 0.80 0.0315 θ 0° 3.5° 7° 0° 3.5° 7° L 0.45 0.60 0.75 0.0177 0.0236 0.0295 L1 1.00 0.0394 Number of pins N 32 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. 13.2.4 SDIP32 package mechanical data Figure 92. 32-pin plastic dual in-line package, shrink 400-mil width E eC A2 A A1 L E1 C eA b2 b e eB D T able 117. 32-pin dual in-line package mechanical data mm inches(1) Dim. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max A 3.56 3.76 5.08 0.1402 0.1480 0.2000 A1 0.51 0.0201 A2 3.05 3.56 4.57 0.1201 0.1402 0.1799 b 0.36 0.46 0.58 0.0142 0.0181 0.0228 b1 0.76 1.02 1.40 0.0299 0.0402 0.0551 C 0.20 0.25 0.36 0.0079 0.0098 0.0142 D 27.43 28.45 1.0799 1.1201 175/193

Package characteristics ST72324Bxx Table 117. 32-pin dual in-line package mechanical data (continued) mm inches(1) Dim. Min Typ Max Min Typ Max E 9.91 10.41 11.05 0.3902 0.4098 0.4350 E1 7.62 8.89 9.40 0.3000 0.3500 0.3701 e 1.78 0.0701 eA 10.16 0.4000 eB 12.70 0.5000 eC 1.40 0.0551 L 2.54 3.05 3.81 0.1000 0.1201 0.1500 Number of pins N 42 1. Values in inches are converted from mm and rounded to 4 decimal digits. 176/193

ST72324Bxx Package characteristics 13.3 Thermal characteristics T a ble 118. Thermal characteristics Symbol Ratings Value Unit Package thermal resistance (junction to ambient): LQFP44 10x10 52 R LQFP32 7x7 70 thJA °C/W DIP42 600mil 55 SDIP32 200mil 50 P Power dissipation(1) 500 mW D T Maximum junction temperature(2) 150 °C Jmax 1. The maximum power dissipation is obtained from the formula P = (T -T ) / R . The power dissipation D J A thJA of an application can be defined by the user with the formula: P =P +P where P is the chip D INT PORT INT internal power (I x V ) and P is the port power dissipation depending on the ports used in the DD DD PORT application. 2. The maximum chip-junction temperature is based on technology characteristics. 177/193

Device configuration and ordering information ST72324Bxx 14 Device configuration and ordering information Each device is available for production in user programmable versions (Flash) as well as in factory coded versions (ROM/FASTROM). ST72324Bxx devices are ROM versions. ST72P324B devices are Factory Advanced Service Technique ROM (FASTROM) versions: They are factory-programmed HDFlash devices. Flash devices are shipped to customers with a default content (FFh), while ROM factory coded parts contain the code supplied by the customer. This implies that Flash devices have to be configured by the customer using the Option bytes while the ROM devices are factory-configured. Figure 93. ST72324Bxx ordering information scheme Example: ST72 F 324B K 2 B 5 Family ST7 microcontroller family Version F = Flash P = FASTROM Blank = ROM Sub-family 324B No. of pins K = 32 J = 42 or 44 Memory size 2 = 8 Kbytes 4 = 16 Kbytes 6 = 32 Kbytes Package B = DIP 1) M = SO U = DFN Temperature range 1 = 0 to +70 °C 5 = -10 to +85 °C 6 = -40 to +85 °C 7 = -40 to +105 °C 3 = -40 to +125 °C For a list of available options (e.g. memory size, package) and orderable part numbers or for further information on any aspect of this device, please contact the ST sales office nearest to you. 178/193

ST72324Bxx Device configuration and ordering information 14.1 Flash devices 14.1.1 Flash configuration Table 119. F lash option bytes Static option byte 0 Static option byte 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 WDG Res VD Reserved P_R PKG1 TC OSCTYPE OSCRANGE OFF M S L HALT SW 1 0 R 1 0 2 1 0 L F P See Default 1 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 note 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 1 1. Depends on device type as defined in Table122: Package selection (OPT7) on page181. The option bytes allow the hardware configuration of the microcontroller to be selected. They have no address in the memory map and can be accessed only in programming mode (for example using a standard ST7 programming tool). The default content of the Flash is fixed to FFh. To program directly the Flash devices using ICP, Flash devices are shipped to customers with the internal RC clock source. In masked ROM devices, the option bytes are fixed in hardware by the ROM code (see option list). T able 120. Option byte 0 bit description Bit Name Function Watchdog reset on Halt This option bit determines if a reset is generated when entering Halt OPT7 WDG HALT mode while the Watchdog is active. 0: No reset generation when entering Halt mode 1: Reset generation when entering Halt mode Hardware or software Watchdog This option bit selects the Watchdog type. OPT6 WDG SW 0: Hardware (Watchdog always enabled) 1: Software (Watchdog to be enabled by software) OPT5 - Reserved, must be kept at default value. Voltage detection These option bits enable the voltage detection block (LVD and AVD) with a selected threshold for the LVD and AVD. 00: Selected LVD = Highest threshold (V ~4V). DD 01: Selected LVD = Medium threshold (V ~3.5V). DD OPT4:3 VD[1:0] 10: Selected LVD = Lowest threshold (V ~3V). DD 11: LVD and AVD off Caution: If the medium or low thresholds are selected, the detection may occur outside the specified operating voltage range. Below 3.8V, device operation is not guaranteed. For details on the AVD and LVD threshold levels refer to Section12.4.1 on page 145. OPT2:1 - Reserved, must be kept at default value 179/193

Device configuration and ordering information ST72324Bxx Table 120. Option byte 0 bit description (continued) Bit Name Function Flash memory readout protection Readout protection, when selected, provides a protection against program memory content extraction and against write access to Flash memory. Erasing the option bytes when the FMP_R option is selected causes OPT0 FMP_R the whole user memory to be erased first, afterwhich the device can be reprogrammed. Refer to Section4.3.1 on page 24 and the ST7 Flash Programming Reference Manual for more details. 0: Readout protection enabled 1: Readout protection disabled T able 121. Option byte 1 bit description Bit Name Function Pin package selection bit This option bit selects the package (see Table122). Note: On the chip, each I/O port has eight pads. Pads that are not OPT7 PKG1 bonded to external pins are in input pull-up configuration after reset. The configuration of these pads must be kept at reset state to avoid added current consumption. Reset clock cycle selection This option bit selects the number of CPU cycles applied during the reset phase and when exiting Halt mode. For resonator oscillators, it OPT6 RSTC is advised to select 4096 due to the long crystal stabilization time. 0: Reset phase with 4096 CPU cycles 1: Reset phase with 256 CPU cycles Oscillator type These option bits select the ST7 main clock source type. 00: Clock source = Resonator oscillator OPT5:4 OSCTYPE[1:0] 01: Reserved 10: Clock source = Internal RC oscillator 11: Clock source = External source Oscillator range When the resonator oscillator type is selected, these option bits select the resonator oscillator current source corresponding to the frequency range of the used resonator. When the external clock source is OPT3:1 OSCRANGE[2:0] selected, these bits are set to medium power (2 ~ 4 MHz). 000: Typ. frequency range (LP) = 1 ~ 2 MHz 001: Typ. frequency range (MP) = 2 ~ 4 MHz 010: Typ. frequency range (MS) = 4 ~ 8 MHz 011: Typ. frequency range (HS) = 8 ~ 16 MHz 180/193

ST72324Bxx Device configuration and ordering information Table 121. Option byte 1 bit description (continued) Bit Name Function PLL activation This option bit activates the PLL which allows multiplication by two of the main input clock frequency. The PLL must not be used with the internal RC oscillator. The PLL is guaranteed only with an input frequency between 2 and 4MHz. OPT0 PLL OFF 0: PLL x2 enabled 1: PLL x2 disabled Caution: The PLL can be enabled only if the “OSCRANGE” (OPT3:1) bits are configured to “MP - 2~4MHz”. Otherwise, the device functionality is not guaranteed. T able 122. Package selection (OPT7) Version Selected package PKG1 J LQFP44/SDIP42 1 K LQFP32/SDIP32 0 14.2 ROM devices 14.2.1 Transfer of customer code Customer code is made up of the ROM/FASTROM contents and the list of the selected options (if any). The ROM/FASTROM contents are to be sent with the S19 hexadecimal file generated by the development tool. All unused bytes must be set to FFh. Complete the appended ST72324Bxx MICROCONTROLLER OPTION LIST on page182 to communicate the selected options to STMicroelectronics. Refer to application note AN1635 for information on the counter listing returned by ST after code has been transferred. Figure93: ST72324Bxx ordering information scheme on page178 serves as a guide for ordering. The STMicroelectronics sales organization will be pleased to provide detailed information on contractual points. Caution: The readout protection binary value is inverted between ROM and Flash products. The option byte checksum differs between ROM and Flash. 181/193

Device configuration and ordering information ST72324Bxx ST72324Bxx MICROCONTROLLER OPTION LIST (Last update: March 2009) Customer: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Address: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Contact: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Phone No: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reference/ROM Code* : . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . *The ROM code name is assigned by STMicroelectronics. ROM code must be sent in .S19 format. .Hex extension cannot be processed. Device type/memory size/package (check only one option): --------------------------------- ------------------------------------- ------------------------------------- ------------------------------------- R-O--M--- -D--E--V--I-C--E--:--------------- | ----------------3--2--K----------------- | ----------------1--6--K----------------- | -----------------8--K------------------ LQFP32: | [ ] | [ ] | [ ] DIP32: | [ ] | [ ] | [ ] LQFP44 : | [ ] | [ ] | [ ] DIP42: | [ ] | [ ] | [ ] --------------------------------- --------------------------------------- --------------------------------------- -------------------------------------- DIE FORM: | 32K | 16K | 8K --------------------------------- --------------------------------------- --------------------------------------- --------------------------------------- 32-pin: | [ ] | [ ] | [ ] 44-pin: | [ ] | [ ] | [ ] Conditioning (check only one option): ------------------------------------------------------------------------ | ----------------------------------------------------- -------------------------------P--a-c--k-a--g--e-d-- -p--r-o-d--u--c-t------------------ | ---D--ie-- -p--r-o-d--u--c-t- -(-d-i-c--e- -t-e--s-t-e--d- -a--t- 2--5-- -°-C-- -o-n--l-y-)- LQFP: [ ] Tape & reel [ ] Tray | [ ] Tape & Reel DIP: [ ] Tube | [ ] Inked wafer | [ ] Sawn wafer on sticky foil Power supply range: [ ] 3.8 to 5.5 V Temp. range (do not check for die product). [ ] 0 °C to +70 °C [ ] -10 °C to +85 °C [ ] -40 °C to +85 °C [ ] -40 °C to +105 °C [ ] -40 °C to +125 °C Special marking: [ ] No [ ] Yes "_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ " (LQFP32 7 char., other pkg. 10 char. max) Authorized characters are letters, digits, '.', '-', '/' and spaces only. Clock source selection: [ ] Resonator: [ ] LP: Low power resonator (1 to 2 MHz) [ ] MP: Medium power resonator (2 to 4 MHz) [ ] MS: Medium speed resonator (4 to 8 MHz) [ ] HS: High speed resonator (8 to 16 MHz) [ ] Internal RC [ ] External clock PLL [ ] Disabled [ ] Enabled LVD Reset [ ] Disabled [ ] High threshold [ ] Med. threshold [ ] Low threshold Reset Delay [ ] 256 Cycles [ ] 4096 Cycles Watchdog selection: [ ] Software activation [ ] Hardware activation Watchdog Reset on Halt: [ ] Reset [ ] No Reset Readout protection: [ ] Disabled [ ] Enabled Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Signature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Caution: The readout protection binary value is inverted between ROM and Flash products. The option byte check- sum will differ between ROM and Flash. 182/193

ST72324Bxx Device configuration and ordering information 14.3 Development tools 14.3.1 Introduction Development tools for the ST7 microcontrollers include a complete range of hardware systems and software tools from STMicroelectronics and third-party tool suppliers. The range of tools includes solutions to help you evaluate microcontroller peripherals, develop and debug your application, and program your microcontrollers. 14.3.2 Evaluation tools and starter kits ST offers complete, affordable starter kits and full-featured evaluation boards that allow you to evaluate microcontroller features and quickly start developing ST7 applications. Starter kits are complete, affordable hardware/software tool packages that include features and samples to help you quickly start developing your application. ST evaluation boards are open-design, embedded systems, which are developed and documented to serve as references for your application design. They include sample application software to help you demonstrate, learn about and implement your ST7’s features. 14.3.3 Development and debugging tools Application development for ST7 is supported by fully optimizing C Compilers and the ST7 Assembler-Linker toolchain, which are all seamlessly integrated in the ST7 integrated development environments in order to facilitate the debugging and fine-tuning of your application. The Cosmic C Compiler is available in a free version that outputs up to 16Kbytes of code. The range of hardware tools includes cost effective ST7-DVP3 series emulators. These tools are supported by the ST7 Toolset from STMicroelectronics, which includes the STVD7 integrated development environment (IDE) with high-level language debugger, editor, project manager and integrated programming interface. 14.3.4 Programming tools During the development cycle, the ST7-DVP3 and ST7-EMU3 series emulators and the RLink provide in-circuit programming capability for programming the Flash microcontroller on your application board. ST also provides dedicated a low-cost dedicated in-circuit programmer, the ST7-STICK, as well as ST7 socket boards which provide all the sockets required for programming any of the devices in a specific ST7 subfamily on a platform that can be used with any tool with in- circuit programming capability for ST7. For production programming of ST7 devices, ST’s third-party tool partners also provide a complete range of gang and automated programming solutions, which are ready to integrate into your production environment. For additional ordering codes for spare parts, accessories and tools available for the ST7 (including from third party manufacturers), refer to the online product selector at www.st.com/mcu. 183/193

Device configuration and ordering information ST72324Bxx Table 123. S TMicroelectronics development tools Emulation Programming Supported ST7 DVP3 series ST7 EMU3 series products ICC socket Active probe board Emulator Connection kit Emulator and TEB ST72324BJ, ST7MDT20- ST72F324BJ ST7MDT20- T44/DVP ST7MDT20J-EMU3 ST7MDT20J-TEB ST7SB20J/xx(1) ST72324BK, DVP3 ST7MDT20- ST72F324BK T32/DVP 1. Add suffix /EU, /UK, /US for the power supply of your region. 14.3.5 Socket and emulator adapter information For information on the type of socket that is supplied with the emulator, refer to the suggested list of sockets in Table124. Note: Before designing the board layout, it is recommended to check the overall dimensions of the socket as they may be greater than the dimensions of the device. For footprint and other mechanical information about these sockets and adapters, refer to the manufacturer’s datasheet (www.yamaichi.de for LQFP44 10x10 and www.ironwoodelectronics.com for LQFP32 7x7). T able 124. Suggested list of socket types Socket Emulator adapter Device (supplied with ST7MDT20J-EMU3) (supplied with ST7MDT20J-EMU3) LQFP32 7X7 IRONWOOD SF-QFE32SA-L-01 IRONWOOD SK-UGA06/32A-01 LQFP44 10X10 YAMAICHI IC149-044-*52-*5 YAMAICHI ICP-044-5 14.4 ST7 Application notes All relevant ST7 application notes can be found on www.st.com. 184/193

ST72324Bxx Known limitations 15 Known limitations 15.1 All Flash and ROM devices 15.1.1 Safe connection of OSC1/OSC2 pins The OSC1 and/or OSC2 pins must not be left unconnected, otherwise the ST7 main oscillator may start and, in this configuration, could generate an f clock frequency in OSC excess of the allowed maximum (>16MHz), putting the ST7 in an unsafe/undefined state. Refer to Section6.3 on page 32. 15.1.2 External interrupt missed To avoid any risk of generating a parasitic interrupt, the edge detector is automatically disabled for one clock cycle during an access to either DDR and OR. Any input signal edge during this period will not be detected and will not generate an interrupt. This case can typically occur if the application refreshes the port configuration registers at intervals during runtime. Workaround The workaround is based on software checking the level on the interrupt pin before and after writing to the PxOR or PxDDR registers. If there is a level change (depending on the sensitivity programmed for this pin) the interrupt routine is invoked using the call instruction with three extra PUSH instructions before executing the interrupt routine (this is to make the call compatible with the IRET instruction at the end of the interrupt service routine). But detection of the level change does not make sure that edge occurs during the critical one cycle duration and the interrupt has been missed. This may lead to occurrence of same interrupt twice (one hardware and another with software call). To avoid this, a semaphore is set to ‘1’ before checking the level change. The semaphore is changed to level '0' inside the interrupt routine. When a level change is detected, the semaphore status is checked and if it is ‘1’ this means that the last interrupt has been missed. In this case, the interrupt routine is invoked with the call instruction. There is another possible case that is, if writing to PxOR or PxDDR is done with global interrupts disabled (interrupt mask bit set). In this case, the semaphore is changed to ‘1’ when the level change is detected. Detecting a missed interrupt is done after the global interrupts are enabled (interrupt mask bit reset) and by checking the status of the semaphore. If it is ‘1’ this means that the last interrupt was missed and the interrupt routine is invoked with the call instruction. To implement the workaround, the following software sequence is to be followed for writing into the PxOR/PxDDR registers. The example is for Port PF1 with falling edge interrupt sensitivity. The software sequence is given for both cases (global interrupt disabled/enabled). 185/193

Known limitations ST72324Bxx Case 1: Writing to PxOR or PxDDR with global interrupts enabled: LD A,#01 LD sema,A; set the semaphore to '1' LD A,PFDR AND A,#02 LD X,A; store the level before writing to PxOR/PxDDR LD A,#$90 LD PFDDR,A ; Write to PFDDR LD A,#$ff LD PFOR,A ; Write to PFOR LD A,PFDR AND A,#02 LD Y,A; store the level after writing to PxOR/PxDDR LD A,X; check for falling edge cp A,#02 jrne OUT TNZ Y jrne OUT LD A,sema ; check the semaphore status if edge is detected CP A,#01 jrne OUT call call_routine ; call the interrupt routine OUT:LD A,#00 LD sema,A .call_routine ; entry to call_routine PUSH A PUSH X PUSH CC .ext1_rt ; entry to interrupt routine LD A,#00 LD sema,A IRET Case 2: Writing to PxOR or PxDDR with global interrupts disabled: SIM ; set the interrupt mask LD A,PFDR AND A,#$02 LD X,A ; store the level before writing to PxOR/PxDDR LD A,#$90 LD PFDDR,A ; Write into PFDDR LD A,#$ff LD PFOR,A ; Write to PFOR LD A,PFDR AND A,#$02 LD Y,A ; store the level after writing to PxOR/PxDDR LD A,X ; check for falling edge cp A,#$02 jrne OUT TNZ Y jrne OUT LD A,#$01 LD sema,A ; set the semaphore to '1' if edge is detected 186/193

ST72324Bxx Known limitations RIM ; reset the interrupt mask LD A,sema ; check the semaphore status CP A,#$01 jrne OUT call call_routine ; call the interrupt routine RIM OUT:RIM JP while_loop .call_routine ; entry to call_routine PUSH A PUSH X PUSH CC .ext1_rt ; entry to interrupt routine LD A,#$00 LD sema,A IRET 15.1.3 Unexpected reset fetch If an interrupt request occurs while a “POP CC” instruction is executed, the interrupt controller does not recognize the source of the interrupt and, by default, passes the reset vector address to the CPU. Workaround To solve this issue, a “POP CC” instruction must always be preceded by a “SIM” instruction. 15.1.4 Clearing active interrupts outside interrupt routine When an active interrupt request occurs at the same time as the related flag is being cleared, an unwanted reset may occur. Note: Clearing the related interrupt mask will not generate an unwanted reset. Concurrent interrupt context The symptom does not occur when the interrupts are handled normally, that is, when: ● The interrupt flag is cleared within its own interrupt routine ● The interrupt flag is cleared within any interrupt routine ● The interrupt flag is cleared in any part of the code while this interrupt is disabled If these conditions are not met, the symptom can be avoided by implementing the following sequence: Perform SIM and RIM operation before and after resetting an active interrupt request. Example: – SIM – Reset interrupt flag – RIM 187/193

Known limitations ST72324Bxx Nested interrupt context The symptom does not occur when the interrupts are handled normally, that is, when: ● The interrupt flag is cleared within its own interrupt routine ● The interrupt flag is cleared within any interrupt routine with higher or identical priority level ● The interrupt flag is cleared in any part of the code while this interrupt is disabled If these conditions are not met, the symptom can be avoided by implementing the following sequence: – PUSH CC – SIM – Reset interrupt flag – POP CC 15.1.5 16-bit timer PWM mode In PWM mode, the first PWM pulse is missed after writing the value FFFCh in the OC1R register (OC1HR, OC1LR). It leads to either full or no PWM during a period, depending on the OLVL1 and OLVL2 settings. 15.1.6 TIMD set simultaneously with OC interrupt If the 16-bit timer is disabled at the same time the output compare event occurs then output compare flag gets locked and cannot be cleared before the timer is enabled again. Impact on the application If output compare interrupt is enabled, then the output compare flag cannot be cleared in the timer interrupt routine. Consequently the interrupt service routine is called repeatedly. Workaround Disable the timer interrupt before disabling the timer. Again while enabling, first enable the timer then the timer interrupts. ● Perform the following to disable the timer: – TACR1 or TBCR1 = 0x00h; // Disable the compare interrupt – TACSR I or TBCSR I = 0x40; // Disable the timer ● Perform the following to enable the timer again: – TACSR & or TBCSR & = ~0x40; // Enable the timer – TACR1 or TBCR1 = 0x40; // Enable the compare interrupt 15.1.7 SCI wrong break duration Description A single break character is sent by setting and resetting the SBK bit in the SCICR2 register. In some cases, the break character may have a longer duration than expected: ● 20 bits instead of 10 bits if M=0 ● 22 bits instead of 11 bits if M=1 188/193

ST72324Bxx Known limitations In the same way, as long as the SBK bit is set, break characters are sent to the TDO pin. This may lead to generate one break more than expected. Occurrence The occurrence of the problem is random and proportional to the baud rate. With a transmit frequency of 19200 baud (f =8MHz and SCIBRR=0xC9), the wrong break duration CPU occurrence is around 1%. Workaround If this wrong duration is not compliant with the communication protocol in the application, software can request that an Idle line be generated before the break character. In this case, the break duration is always correct assuming the application is not doing anything between the idle and the break. This can be ensured by temporarily disabling interrupts. The exact sequence is: 1. Disable interrupts 2. Reset and set TE (IDLE request) 3. Set and reset SBK (break request) 4. Re-enable interrupts 15.2 8/16 Kbyte Flash devices only 15.2.1 39-pulse ICC entry mode ICC mode entry using ST7 application clock (39 pulses) is not supported. External clock mode must be used (36 pulses). Refer to the ST7 Flash Programming Reference Manual. 15.2.2 Negative current injection on pin PB0 Negative current injection on pin PB0 degrades the performance of the device and is not allowed on this pin. 15.3 8/16 Kbyte ROM devices only 15.3.1 Readout protection with LVD Readout protection is not supported if the LVD is enabled. 15.3.2 I/O Port A and F configuration When using an external quartz crystal or ceramic resonator, a few f clock periods may OSC2 be lost when the signal pattern in Table125 occurs. This is because this pattern causes the device to enter test mode and return to user mode after a few clock periods. User program execution and I/O status are not changed, only a few clock cycles are lost. This happens with either one of the following configurations ● PA3=0, PF4=1, PF1=0 while PLL option is disabled and PF0 is toggling ● PA3=0, PF4=1, PF1=0, PF0=1 while PLL option is enabled This is detailed in Table125. 189/193

Known limitations ST72324Bxx T able 125. Port A and F configuration PLL PA3 PF4 PF1 PF0 Clock disturbance Maximum 2 clock cycles lost at each rising or falling Off 0 1 0 Toggling edge of PF0 On 0 1 0 1 Maximum 1 clock cycle lost out of every 16 As a consequence, for cycle-accurate operations, these configurations are prohibited in either input or output mode. Workaround To avoid this from occurring, it is recommended to connect one of these pins to GND (PF4 or PF0) or V (PA3 or PF1). DD 190/193

ST72324Bxx Revision history 16 Revision history T able 126. Document revision history Date Revision Changes Merged ST72F324 Flash with ST72324B ROM datasheet. Vt POR max modified in Section 12.4 on page 145 Added Figure79 on page164 05-May-2004 2.0 Modified V min in “10-bit ADC characteristics” on page168 AREF Modified I INJ for PB0 in Section 12.9 on page 158 Added “Clearing active interrupts outside interrupt routine” on page187 Modified “32K ROM DEVICES ONLY” on page165 Removed Clock Security System (CSS) throughout document Added notes on ST72F324B 8K/16K Flash devices in Table 27 Corrected MCO description in Section 10.2 on page 69 Modified VtPOR in Section 12.4 on page 145 Static current consumption modified in Section 12.9 on page 158 Updated footnote and Figure78 on page163 and Figure79 on page164 Modified Soldering information in Section13.6 30-Mar-2005 3 Updated Section 14 on page 178 Added Table 27 Modified Figure8 on page25 and note 4 in “Flash program memory” on page23 Added limitation on ICC entry mode with 39 pulses to “Known limitations” on page185 Added Section 16 on page 166 for ST72F324B 8K/16K Flash devices Modified “Internal Sales Types on box label” in Table29 on page157 Removed notes related to ST72F324, refer to datasheet rev 3 for specifications on older devices. Note: This datasheet rev refers only to ST72F324B and ST72324B. Changed character transmission procedure in Section on page 112 Updated Vt POR max in Section 12.4 on page 145 Updated Current Consumption for in Section 12.5 on page 146 12-Sep-2005 4 Added oscillator diagram and table to Section 12.6.3 on page 150 Increased Data retention max. parameter in Section 12.7.2 on page 154 Updated ordering Section 14.3 on page 155 and Section 14.5 on page 157 Updated Development tools Section 14.3 on page 183 Added “external interrupt missed” in Section 15.1 on page 185 Added description of SICSR register at address 2Bh in Table3 on page20 Changed description on port PF2 to add internal pull-up in Section9.5.1 on page 63 06-Feb-2006 5 Highlighted note in SPI “Master mode operation” on page99 Changed “Static latch-up” on page157 Added note 5 on analog input static current consumption “General characteristics” on page158 Updated notes in “Thermal characteristics” on page177 191/193

Revision history ST72324Bxx Table 126. Document revision history (continued) Date Revision Changes Removed references to automotive versions (these are covered by separate ST72324B-Auto datasheet). Changed Flash endurance to 1 Kcycles at 55°C Replaced TQFP with LQFP in package outline and device summary on page 1 Figure1 on page14: Replaced 60 Kbytes with 32 Kbytes in program memory block Replaced TQFP with LQFP in Figure2 on page15, in Figure4 on page16 and in Table2 on page17 Changed note 3 in Section9.2.1 on page 58 Changed Section10.1.3 on page 65 Changed Master mode operation on page99 10-Oct-2007 6 Added unit of measure to LVD supply current in Section12.5.3 on page 148 Replaced TQFP with LQFP in Section12.8.2 on page 156 Changed note 4 in Section12.9.1 on page 158 Changed Figure78 on page163 Removed EMC protective circuitry in Figure79 on page164 (device works correctly without these components) Changed titles of Figure89 on page172 and Figure91 on page174 Replaced TQFP with LQFP in Section13.3 on page 177 Changed Section13.6 on page 171 Replaced TQFP with LQFP in Section14.1 on page 179, in Table122 on page181, in SectionTable 122. on page 182 and in Section14.3.5 on page 184 Removed soldering information section. In Section10.6.3: Functional description on page129, modified “Starting the conversion” paragraph: added “ or a write to any bit of the ADCCSR register”. Modified t values in Table101: Dual voltage HDFlash memory on RET page154 . 17-Mar-2009 7 Section13.2: Package mechanical data on page172 modified (values in inches rounded to 4 decimal digits). Modified Section12.8.3: Absolute maximum ratings (electrical sensitivity) on page157 (removed DLU and V ). ESD (MM) Added Section13.1: ECOPACK on page172. Modified “Device configuration and ordering information” on page178. 192/193

ST72324Bxx Please Read Carefully: Information in this document is provided solely in connection with ST products. STMicroelectronics NV and its subsidiaries (“ST”) reserve the right to make changes, corrections, modifications or improvements, to this document, and the products and services described herein at any time, without notice. All ST products are sold pursuant to ST’s terms and conditions of sale. Purchasers are solely responsible for the choice, selection and use of the ST products and services described herein, and ST assumes no liability whatsoever relating to the choice, selection or use of the ST products and services described herein. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise, to any intellectual property rights is granted under this document. If any part of this document refers to any third party products or services it shall not be deemed a license grant by ST for the use of such third party products or services, or any intellectual property contained therein or considered as a warranty covering the use in any manner whatsoever of such third party products or services or any intellectual property contained therein. UNLESS OTHERWISE SET FORTH IN ST’S TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE ST DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY WITH RESPECT TO THE USE AND/OR SALE OF ST PRODUCTS INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE (AND THEIR EQUIVALENTS UNDER THE LAWS OF ANY JURISDICTION), OR INFRINGEMENT OF ANY PATENT, COPYRIGHT OR OTHER INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHT. UNLESS EXPRESSLY APPROVED IN WRITING BY AN AUTHORIZED ST REPRESENTATIVE, ST PRODUCTS ARE NOT RECOMMENDED, AUTHORIZED OR WARRANTED FOR USE IN MILITARY, AIR CRAFT, SPACE, LIFE SAVING, OR LIFE SUSTAINING APPLICATIONS, NOR IN PRODUCTS OR SYSTEMS WHERE FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION MAY RESULT IN PERSONAL INJURY, DEATH, OR SEVERE PROPERTY OR ENVIRONMENTAL DAMAGE. ST PRODUCTS WHICH ARE NOT SPECIFIED AS "AUTOMOTIVE GRADE" MAY ONLY BE USED IN AUTOMOTIVE APPLICATIONS AT USER’S OWN RISK. Resale of ST products with provisions different from the statements and/or technical features set forth in this document shall immediately void any warranty granted by ST for the ST product or service described herein and shall not create or extend in any manner whatsoever, any liability of ST. ST and the ST logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of ST in various countries. Information in this document supersedes and replaces all information previously supplied. The ST logo is a registered trademark of STMicroelectronics. All other names are the property of their respective owners. © 2009 STMicroelectronics - All rights reserved STMicroelectronics group of companies Australia - Belgium - Brazil - Canada - China - Czech Republic - Finland - France - Germany - Hong Kong - India - Israel - Italy - Japan - Malaysia - Malta - Morocco - Singapore - Spain - Sweden - Switzerland - United Kingdom - United States of America www.st.com 193/193

Mouser Electronics Authorized Distributor Click to View Pricing, Inventory, Delivery & Lifecycle Information: S TMicroelectronics: ST72F324BK2T6 ST72F324BK6T6 ST72F324BJ2B6 ST72F324BJ2T6 ST72F324BJ4T3 ST72F324BJ4T6 ST72F324BJ6B6 ST72F324BJ6T3 ST72F324BJ6T6 ST72F324BK4B6 ST72F324BK4T3 ST72F324BK4T6 ST72F324BK6T3